Fostex Musical Instrument VF80 User Manual

8588 011 000  
(356698)  
Owner’s Manual  
Digital Multitracker  
INPUT A  
BAL  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PHONES  
INPUT B  
BAL  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F3  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Instructions/Precautions  
Precautions  
About power supply  
Precautions upon handling the HD  
• Be sure to connect the VF80 to the power supply specified  
in the Specifications section of this owner’s manual.  
Do not use an AC outlet of any other voltage.  
• Do not connect the VF80 to the same AC outlet to which  
devices that could generate noise (such as a large motor  
or dimmer), or the devices that consume a large amount  
of power (such as an air conditioning system or large  
electric heater) are connected.  
• Before turning the power off to the VF80, first quit setup  
mode and make sure that the recorder section is stopped.  
Especially, neverattempttoturnoffthepowertotheVF80  
while the hard disk is accessing data (the HD ACCESS LED  
is lit or flashing). Otherwise, not only will you lose  
recorded data, but you may damage to the VF80.  
Fostexisnotresponsibleforthedatalostduringoperation  
of the VF80.  
• If you use the VF80 in an area with a different power  
voltage, first consult your dealer or the nearest Fostex  
service station. You can use the VF80 with a power  
frequency of 50Hz or 60Hz.  
• It is very dangerous to use a power cord that is frayed or  
damage. In such a case, stop using the VF80 immediately  
and ask your dealer to repair the cord.  
• Before you change the location of the VF80, pack the unit  
in the shipping carton or an impact-resistant case.  
Make sure that the VF80 is kept free from external  
vibration or impact since the VF80 is very sensitive to  
vibration.  
• Do not install the VF80 in locations subject to the  
following:  
• To avoid possible electric shock and damage to the VF80,  
avoidcontactwithwaterorotherliquids, ordonothandle  
the power plug while your hands are wet.  
* Extremely high or low temperature, or significant  
changes in temperature.  
* Excessive humidity or dust.  
• To prevent possible electric shock and damage to the  
VF80, do not remove the main unit cover or reach the  
inside the VF80.  
* Excessive changes in power supply voltage.  
* Unstable or significantly vibrating or shaking  
surfaces.  
• Do not let water or other liquid, or metal objects such as  
pins, accidentally enter the inside of the VF80 because  
this may lead to electric shock or damage. Should water  
enter the inside of the VF80, remove the power plug from  
AC outlet, and consult your dealer or the nearest FOSTEX  
service station.  
• To prevent damage to the VF80, be sure to power on the  
connected devices first, then turn on the power to the  
VF80. When you remove or connect the cables to the  
input/output connectors on the VF80, make sure that the  
track and master faders and volume controls are set to  
“0.”  
* Near a strong magnetic field (such as a TV or  
speaker).  
• If you move the unit from a place with an excessively low  
temperature to a warm place, or if you use the VF80 in a  
roominwhichthetemperaturevariessignificantlyduring  
winter, condensation may occur on the hard disk or other  
parts. In such cases, leave the VF80 for about an hour in  
the new location before you turn on the power.  
Note on repair  
• The VF80 does not use any parts that user can repair  
easily. Contact your dealer or the nearest FOSTEX service  
station to ask about repairs.  
Important!  
• Use the packing carton designed for the VF80 when you  
transport the VF80 to the dealer for repair or return.  
If you have discarded the packing box, try to pack the  
VF08 completely using shock absorbing materials.  
Fostex is not responsible for malfunction or damage due  
to incomplete packaging or caused during transport.  
Equipment name, electrical  
ratings, serial number and  
other information for the  
VF80, are written on bottom  
side.  
MODEL VF80  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
FOSTEX  
230V~  
20W  
50/60Hz  
SERIAL NO.  
FOSTEX CORP.  
MADE IN CHINA  
Delay of display indication  
About copyrights  
• While using the VF80, you may have an experience to see  
the delay of the reaction of the time counter or level  
meters. This is not a malfunction and it bears no relation  
to the actual sound to be recorded or played.  
• It is prohibited by law to use any part of a CD recording  
or video images or audio data for which copyright is  
possessed by a third party for commercial purposes such  
as contents, broadcasts, sales, or distribution-any  
purpose other than for your personal pleasure.  
Time counter  
About damage  
• Fostex is not responsible for any “direct damage” or  
“indirect damage” caused by using the VF80.  
Level meters  
This kind of delay is due to the VF80 design concept in which  
the audio processing takes priority over the display  
processing when the audio processing gets busy (e.g. when  
a sudden fader level change happens). You may always trust  
the VF80 to record or playback audio in good condition.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
“See this pageinformation by subject  
The following shows reference pages where you can find information you need.  
See also “The table of contents” shown on page 6.  
I want to record my performance.  
I want to delete a program.  
Please read page 62.  
Please read pages 28 and 30.  
I want to replace a part of the previous recording  
with a new recording.  
I want to locate the desired position.  
Please read pages 32 and 59.  
Please read page 33.  
I want to format a hard disk.  
I want to copy a part of a song to another track.  
Please read page 20.  
Please read page 63.  
I want to exchange tracks.  
Please read page 68.  
I want to mixdown tracks to an external  
master recorder.  
Please read pages 38 and 76.  
I want to know details about the demonstration song.  
I want to create multiple programs.  
Please read page 24.  
Please read page 61.  
I want to know details about the internal effects.  
I want to control theVF80 via MIDI.  
Please read page 44.  
Please read pages 91, 92, and 94.  
I want to save or load the mixing setting.  
I want to make my original CD.  
Please read page 52.  
Please read page 115.  
I want to cue audio at fast speed to search the  
desired position.  
I want to record audio on a CD or MD disc  
to theVF80 digitally.  
Please read page 56.  
Please read page 90.  
I want to scrub audio to search the desired position.  
I want to make a backup of song data.  
Please read page 57.  
Please read page 96.  
I want to record or playback audio by  
altering the speed.  
I want to use a condenser microphone.  
Please read page 27.  
Please read page 58.  
I want to equalize the sound.  
I want to record audio with applying the  
internal effects.  
Please read pages 36 and 40.  
Please read pages 37, 45, 76 and 83.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
I want to put a desired name to a program.  
I want to save song data to a DAT.  
Please read page 62.  
Please read page 97.  
I want to record a material while monitoring  
the input signal.  
I want to make a tempo map.  
Please read pages 122 and 124.  
Please read page 72.  
I want to install the optional CD-RW/CD-R drive.  
Please read page 134.  
I want to mixdown tracks without using  
an external master recorder.  
Please read page 79.  
I want to erase unnecessary songs.  
I want to set the MTC offset time.  
Please read pages 62 and 66.  
Please read page 127.  
I want to know details about the training mode.  
I want to synchronize theVF80 with an external  
device.  
Please read page 74.  
Please read page 91.  
I want to know details about the mastering mode.  
I want to feed the MIDI sync signal to an  
external MIDI device.  
Please read page 76.  
Please read page 126.  
I want to make track bouncing (ping-pong recording).  
Please read page 73.  
I want to know format information of a hard disk.  
Please read page 132.  
I want to protect a recorded program.  
Please read page 129.  
I want to exchange the hard disk.  
Please read page 21.  
I want to save song data by theWAV file format.  
Please read page 109.  
I want to save song data to a CD-RW/CD-R disc.  
Please read page 102.  
I want to control panning.  
I want to copy a song recorded on a CD  
available on the market.  
Please read pages 36 and 40.  
I want to delete unnecessary programs.  
Please read page 118.  
Please read page 62.  
I want to repeat playback of the desired part.  
I want to know details about the insert effect.  
Please read page 59.  
Please read page 83.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Contents  
• Safety Instructions ........................................2  
Recording .................................................................. 29  
Playback .................................................................... 29  
• Precautions ........................................................ 3  
About power supply ................................................... 3  
Precautions upon handling the hard disk................. 3  
Note on repair ............................................................. 3  
About copyright.......................................................... 3  
About damage ............................................................. 3  
• Basic recording (recording onto two track)..... 30  
Preparation for recording ........................................ 30  
Recording .................................................................. 31  
Playback .................................................................... 31  
• Mark function ................................................... 32  
Setting a mark on the fly .......................................... 32  
Locating a mark ........................................................ 32  
Deleting a mark ........................................................ 32  
Basic Features ofVF80  
• Product Features................................................ 9  
• ABS Locate....................................................... 33  
• Before Operating .............................................. 10  
RECORDING method ................................................. 10  
Program..................................................................... 10  
Remain Indicator ...................................................... 10  
Additional track........................................................ 11  
INPUT monitor and REPRO monitor ........................ 11  
Event.......................................................................... 11  
Trim ........................................................................... 12  
Time Base .................................................................. 12  
• Punch In/Out .................................................... 33  
Manual punch in/out using the keys on the unit ... 33  
Punch in/out using the Foot Switch ........................ 33  
Auto punch in/out function .................................... 34  
• Mixing ............................................................... 36  
Adjusting levels ........................................................ 36  
Setting PAN position ................................................. 36  
Adjusting EQ ............................................................. 36  
Setting effects............................................................ 37  
Names and Functions  
• Mix Down .......................................................... 38  
Analog Mix Down ...................................................... 38  
Digital Mix Down ...................................................... 38  
Top panel (Analog input/output section) .............. 14  
Top panel (Mixer section) ........................................ 15  
Top panel (Recorder/display section) .................... 16  
Rear panel ................................................................. 19  
Side Panel .................................................................. 19  
Mixer Functions  
• Initial condition when turning the power ......... 39  
About the hard disk storage device  
• Operations while the Normal display is shown 39  
Fader.......................................................................... 39  
Track mute ................................................................ 39  
Master fader mute .................................................... 39  
Reformatting the Hard Disk ..................................... 20  
Replacing a Hard Disk .............................................. 21  
Formatting the New Hard Disk ................................ 23  
• Mix Parameter Edit ........................................... 40  
Adjusting PAN position ........................................... 40  
Editing EQ ............................................................... 41  
Preset entries in the EQ library ........................... 42  
Setting effects ......................................................... 44  
Basic Recording and Playback  
• About a demonstration song! .......................... 24  
• Connections of external equipment ................ 25  
How to make the loop effect setting ....................... 45  
Setting effect send levels ..................................... 46  
Selecting an effect type........................................ 47  
Selecting pre/post of the effect send .................. 47  
Turning the effect processor on or off................ 48  
About the effect types.......................................... 49  
Scene memory ........................................................ 52  
Storing the current scene .................................... 52  
Recalling a scene .................................................. 52  
Deleting a scene ................................................... 53  
Fader adjust.......................................................... 53  
Scene sequence ......................................................54  
• LCD ................................................................... 26  
Display when turning on the power ........................ 26  
Switching the time base............................................ 26  
“Disk remain” indication ......................................... 26  
• Preliminary knowledge .................................... 27  
Inputs and tracks ...................................................... 27  
How to use condenser microphones........................ 27  
• Basic recording (recording onto a single track) .. 28  
Preparation for recording ........................................ 28  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Assigning scene memories to the mark map ...... 54  
Deleting a mark from the mark map .................. 55  
Scene sequence on/off selection ......................... 55  
Executing the scene sequence ............................. 55  
Track bounce (Ping-pong recording) ............... 73  
On/Off of bounce mode ............................................. 73  
Setting pan position ................................................... 73  
Setting level of each track .......................................... 73  
Performing the track bounce ..................................... 73  
Training mode ................................................... 74  
Connecting the instrument and headphones ........ 74  
On/Off of training mode ....................................... 74  
Slowing down the playback speed......................... 75  
Changing the pitch ................................................ 75  
Canceling the center-positioned sound ................. 75  
Setting the cancel position .................................... 75  
Boosting the bass sound ........................................ 75  
Playing along with the playback sound ................. 75  
Recorder Functions  
• Cueing .............................................................. 56  
Cueing with the [F FWD]/[REWIND] keys ...............56  
Shuttle cueing ......................................................... 56  
Digital scrubbing ..................................................... 57  
Performing digital scrubbing .............................. 57  
Storing the digital scrub point ............................ 57  
• Mastering mode ............................................... 76  
Selecting a program to be played back .................. 76  
On/Off of mastering mode .................................... 76  
Setting the mastering effects ................................. 77  
On/Off the mastering effects ................................. 77  
Recording onto the master recorder ..................... 77  
Effect library details .............................................. 77  
Variable Pitch .................................................... 58  
Turning on or off the vari pitch function ............... 58  
Setting the Speed ...................................................... 58  
• Loop Function .................................................. 59  
Setting the start and end points .............................59  
Capturing the current position on the fly .......... 59  
Editing the position via the screen ..................... 59  
Setting the start and end points by marks ......... 60  
Carrying out the loop playback............................... 60  
• Internal mastering function ............................. 79  
Rehearsing internal mastering .................................. 80  
Performing internal mastering .................................. 81  
About Start and End points ................................... 82  
• Program ............................................................ 61  
Creating a new program ........................................... 61  
Selecting a program.................................................. 62  
Deleting a program................................................... 62  
Editing a program title ............................................. 62  
• Using the insert effect ...................................... 83  
Rehearsal ................................................................. 84  
Recording the guitar ................................................. 85  
Recording with effect ................................................ 86  
Track editing ..................................................... 63  
Copy & Paste and Move & Paste .............................63  
Performing Copy (or Move) Paste ....................... 64  
Undo/redo of Copy (or Move) Paste ................... 65  
Erasing track data ................................................... 66  
Erasing .................................................................. 66  
Undo/redo of Erase.............................................. 67  
Track Exchange .......................................................68  
Performing the track exchange ........................... 68  
• Digital Recording ............................................. 90  
Recording an external source onto theVF80 digitally 90  
Selecting a program to be recorded ...................... 90  
Selecting the digital input ..................................... 90  
Selecting a track to record ..................................... 90  
Starting to record .................................................. 90  
• MIDI Clock Sync System .................................. 91  
Connecting to external equipment ........................ 91  
Setup of the VF80 .................................................. 92  
Executing of recording .......................................... 92  
Confirming the MIDI clock sync ............................ 92  
• Editing marks ................................................... 69  
Viewing the mark list ............................................... 69  
Editing a mark position ........................................... 69  
Enter a mark title ..................................................... 70  
Adding a mark ......................................................... 70  
Deleting a mark .......................................................71  
Locating a mark .......................................................71  
• MIDI Sync/MIDI Machine Control System ........ 92  
Connecting to external equipment ........................ 93  
Setup of external equipment ................................. 93  
Setup of the VF80 .................................................. 93  
Confirming MTC sync/MMC ................................. 93  
Executing of recording .......................................... 93  
Advanced Operations  
ExternalMIDIequipmentSyncSystembytheSlaveMode..94  
Connecting to external equipment ........................ 94  
Setup of external equipment ................................. 94  
Setup of the VF80 .................................................. 94  
Confirming chase lock ........................................... 94  
Executing of recording .......................................... 95  
• Metronome function......................................... 72  
Setting the tempo map ............................................... 72  
Setting the metronome output................................... 72  
Setting the time base to bar/beat ............................... 72  
Monitoring the metronome sound ............................ 72  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
• Setting the Record Protect function .............. 129  
• Setting Digital Input ....................................... 130  
• Setting BAR/BEAT Resolution mode............. 130  
• Setting the MIDI device number..................... 131  
• Checking the number of track events............ 131  
• The Drive Format Information........................ 132  
• Fader Fix mode Setting .................................. 132  
• Fader Recall mode Setting............................. 133  
Save/Load of Song Data  
• About Song Data .............................................. 96  
Items that can be saved or loaded as song data ......... 97  
• Save/load using the S/PDIF digital signal........ 97  
Notes for digital audio recorder to be used ................ 97  
Notes for saving data using the S/P DIF digital signal 97  
Saving data using the S/P DIF digital signal .............. 98  
Connecting to an external digital recorder............ 98  
Setting the external recorder................................. 98  
Saving data ............................................................ 98  
Loading data using the S/P DIF digital signal .......... 100  
Connecting to an external digital recorder.......... 100  
Setting the external recorder............................... 100  
Loading data........................................................ 100  
Appendix  
• Save/load using CD-RW/CD-R ....................... 102  
Please read this first! ................................................ 102  
Saving data using a CD-RW drive (Backup) ............. 104  
Loading backup data from a CD-RW drive ............... 107  
• Installing the CD-1A ....................................... 134  
How to install the CD-1A .......................................... 135  
Opening/closing the tray ......................................... 136  
Placing/removing a disc .......................................... 136  
Saving aWAV file .................................................... 109  
Important notes for using a WAV file .................. 109  
About WAV file saved .......................................... 112  
Loading aWAV file .................................................. 113  
Special loading method when using a computer.. 114  
Making an audio CD ................................................ 115  
Others  
• MIDI Implementation Chart ............................ 137  
• MMC Command List....................................... 138  
• Inquiry Message List...................................... 138  
• Maintenance ................................................... 139  
• Specifications ................................................ 139  
• Block Diagram................................................ 140  
• Dimensions .................................................... 141  
Loading from an audio CD ...................................... 118  
SETUP Mode  
To enter the SETUP mode .............................. 122  
Time Signature Setting ................................... 122  
New Registering of Time Signature .......................... 122  
Correcting the Registered Time Signature ............... 122  
Deleting of Time Signature ...................................... 122  
Clearing All Time Signature data ............................. 122  
Changing the Bar Offset Figure ................................ 122  
• Setting aTempo .............................................. 124  
New Registering of Tempo ....................................... 124  
Correction of the Registered Tempo ........................ 124  
Erasing of the Registered Tempo ............................. 124  
• Setting the Metronome function .................... 125  
• Setting MIDI sync output signal ..................... 126  
• Setting an MTC frame rate ............................. 126  
• Setting an MTC offset value ........................... 127  
• Setting MTC offset mode ............................... 127  
• Setting the Slave mode .................................. 128  
• Setting the Slave type .................................... 128  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Features of VF80  
Basic Features ofVF80  
The VF80 Digital Multitracker incorporates a digital mixer with an 8-track (plus 16-additional track)  
digital recorder.  
The digital mixer section features a high-performance DSP multi-effect processor employing the A.S.P.  
(Fostex Advanced Signal Processing) technology originally developed by Fostex. The digital recorder  
section allows you to record and playback uncompressed linear 16-bit/44.1 kHz digital audio.  
You can make all process for music production such as overdubbing, track bounce, effect processing,  
mixdown and mastering in the digital domain without sound deterioration.  
In addition, by installing the optional CD-RW drive (Model CD-1A), you can save/load to /from CD-  
RW/CD-R discs (the WAV file format also supported), as well as create original audio CDs.  
Product Features  
Recorder Section  
Mixer Section  
• Employs the Fostex original FDMS-3 (Fostex Disk  
• Built in a high-performance DSP multi-effect  
Management System-3) format, allowing high quality  
processor employing the A.S.P. (Fostex Advanced  
recording/playback with uncompressed linear 16-bit/  
Signal Processing) technology  
44.1 kHz digital audio on 8 tracks, as well as 16  
additional tracks. You can record about 3 hours of  
mono audio per 1 GB disk space.  
• 7 track faders and a stereo master fader allow you to  
control signal levels intuitively.  
• The track ON/OFF switch is provided for each track.  
The 2-band EQ with the EQ library and the effect send  
with PRE/POST selection are provided for Tracks 1  
through 6.  
• Nondestructive audio editing functions such as copy,  
paste, move, erase and undo/redo are possible.  
• The "Program" function allows you to give a title to  
each song and manage up to 99 titles.  
• Both balanced (XLR) and unbalanced (1/4" phone)  
connectors are provided for each analog input.  
The phantom power is also available when using the  
balanced connector. Also the trim knob on each input  
makes it possible to accept a wide range of input  
signals from microphone to line levels.  
• +/- 6.0% pitch control.  
• Accepts S/PDIF digital signal and records it directly  
onto any VF80 track.  
• The auto punch in/out function with rehearsal mode.  
The IN and OUT points can be set with 1/100 frame  
accuracy. You can also carry out punch in/out manu  
ally using the foot switch.  
• "Bounce" function allows bouncing signals from tracks  
1 through 6 to tracks 7/8 with a single key operation.  
• The mastering mode allows transferring audio on the  
master tracks (7/8) to an external recorder with  
applying the EQ, reverb and compressor.  
Others  
• Dot-matrix LCD and self-illuminating keys allow you  
to know the current status visually, as well as to make  
settings of the mixer and recorder easily.  
• The “REC EFFECT” function allows you to rerecord a  
recorded track while applying an effect (insert effect).  
Some distortion and simulation effects are available  
only for the insert effect.  
• Durable and reliable 3.5-inch E-IDE standard hard  
disk is built in.  
• "Trainingmode"helpsyoutopracticeyourinstrument  
by slowing down playback, shifting the pitch of the  
recorded performance or masking the solo  
instrument/voice.  
• Save/load of song data using the S/PDIF (optical)  
signal is possible.  
• By installing the optional CD-RW drive (Model CD-1A),  
you can save/load data to/from CD-RW/CD-R discs.  
• "Scene memory" function allows you to save and load  
up to 99 mixer scenes including fader positions and  
EQ/effect settings.  
• Feeds MIDI clock with song position pointer or MTC  
(MIDI Time Code).  
• Supports MMC (MIDI Machine Control).  
• Can be slaved to an external MTC.  
• You can feed the mixed-down signal from the S/PDIF  
output connector to an external digital device such as  
a DAT recorder for digital recording.  
• The internal metronome function can be used for  
recording a guide track.  
• The “Internal Mastering” function allows you to make  
mastering to VF80’s internal tracks, without the need  
of an external master recorder.  
In addition, by installing the CD-RW drive (Model CD-  
1A), you can create original audio CDs using mastered  
materials.  
• The bar/beat resolution function allows editing by  
beat (the clock digit is omitted).  
• Up to 99 mark points can be set per each song.  
You can locate any mark point or make the mark map  
of a scene.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Features of VF80  
Before Operating  
This section describes the basics that you should know before you start operating the VF80.  
All users, including those who are familiar with using tape-based Multitracker and those who are new  
to Multitracker, should read this section thoroughly to understand the functions of the VF80.  
Recording method  
Remain indicator  
The VF80 uses a hard disk as a recording medium,  
instead of a conventional tape.  
Theremainindicatorshowshowmuchrecordingtime  
is left on the current hard disk.  
You can start recording sound sources from any point  
on a disk as long as the point is within the range of 24  
hours in ABS time. Also you locate any point within  
the range. You may think of the VF80 as incorporat-  
ing tapes on which 24-hour time information is  
striped.  
The VF80 program is managed by a 24-hour time  
counter, however, the actual recording time left de-  
pends on the available disk space.  
The remain indicator appears on the LCD during re-  
cording (or on REC standby), showing the rough re-  
maining time if you record on a mono track.  
ABS0  
REC END  
15m 00s  
23h 59m 59s  
......  
00m 00s  
05m 00s  
10m 00s  
Note that if the remaining time is 100 hours or more,  
the indicator shows the available (remaining) disk  
space in MB.  
recorded area unrecorded area recorded area unrecorded area  
You can record at any point within 24 hours in ABS time.  
Youcanrecordinanyareawithin24hoursinABStime.  
ABS 0: The beginning time at 00H 00M 00S  
REC END: The end time of recording (in the example  
above, 00H 15M 00S)  
The remaining time is 13h 28m 15s.  
24 hour recording  
5 minute recording 5 minute recording  
unrecorded  
......  
recorded area recorded area unrecorded area (remain)  
With a tape recorder, the maximum recording time  
depends on the tape length, regardless of the amount  
of unrecorded areas. With the VF80, you can use the  
media more efficiently because no disk space is used  
for unrecorded areas.  
The remaining value is calculated on a mono-track  
basis. That is, the value indicates recordable time if  
you record on a mono track. You can calculate the  
recordable time when recording on more than one  
track easily by dividing the time by the track num-  
ber.  
Program  
You can use up to 99 "tapes with 24-hour time infor-  
mation" with the VF80. Each "tape" is called a "Pro-  
gram".  
A program exists independently on the hard disk,  
therefore, you can freely record, playback or edit each  
program without affecting other programs.  
You can give a name (program title) to each program,  
so you can easily identify a program.  
In the example above, if you record on 2 tracks, the  
recordabletimeisabout6hours44minutes(13hours  
28 minutes 15 seconds divided by 2). Or if you record  
on 8 tracks, the recordable time is about 1 hour 41  
minutes (13 hours 28 minutes 15 seconds divided by  
8).  
"Program title" with its program number appears at  
the top left of the normal screen as shown below.  
The VF80 manages up to 99 programs on the hard  
disk. Each program includes not only the recording  
data but also various setting information which con-  
sumes a small amount of disk space. Therefore, note  
thattheremainingtimeshownonthescreenisarough  
value.  
Program number/title ("01" is the program number while  
"#0001" is a default title)  
Always check the remaining time left before starting  
recording, to ensure that you have enough disk space  
to work with.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Features of VF80  
Additional track  
Event  
A program on the VF80 consists of 24 tracks. Tracks  
1 through 8 are called "Real tracks" which you can  
record, playback and edit. Tracks 9 through 24 are  
called"Additionaltracks". Usingthe"TrackExchange"  
function, you can exchange between "real track(s)"  
and "additional track(s)" in one-track, 2-track or 8-  
track block.  
Each time you make a recording, an independent  
audio file is created on each recorded track. A silent  
part on a track is also recognized as a file.  
These files (audio files and silent files) are called  
"events".  
With the VF80, you can create up to 512 events per  
track. You cannot make any further recording when  
512 events are created. In the normal use, 512 events  
are enough.  
The VF80 can show the current number of events on  
the LCD. It also shows a warning message if you are  
going to make recording when 512 events already  
exist. You may resolve this problem by saving the  
program (see "Save/Load of a program").  
Let's count the events for each recording step (A  
through E) below.  
This makes it possible to record solo on several tracks,  
exchange tracks and compare the results, or to record  
different rhythm versions using multiple tracks, ex-  
change the rhythm tracks completely and making a  
remix version.  
Note that tracks 9 through 24 cannot be recorded,  
played or edited. The tracks you want to work with  
must be set as tracks 1 through 8.  
One track exchange  
A.Before recording, there is a single event (silent file) on the track  
(the VF80 recognizes a silent part as a file).  
8 track block exchange  
Track 1  
Track 2  
Track 3  
Track 4  
Track 5  
Track 6  
Track 7  
Track 8  
Track 17  
Track 18  
Track 19  
Track 20  
Track 21  
Track 22  
Track 23  
Track 24  
Track 9  
Track 10  
Track 11  
Track 12  
Track 13  
Track 14  
Track 15  
Track 16  
B.After making a recording (REC B), there are two events on  
the track;the recorded audio file and the following silent part.  
C.After making another recording (REC C) continuously from  
the end point of REC B, there are three events on the track;  
two audio files and the following silent part.  
D.After locating a point ahead of REC C and then making an  
other recording (REC D), there are totally five events on the  
track.Note that a silent file is created between Rec C and Rec  
D.  
2 track block exchange  
8 track block exchange  
E.After making a recording (REC E) over REC B and REC C,  
there are four events on the track.  
Input monitor and Repro monitor  
A
B
C
D
E
Silence  
There are two modes for monitoring a track of the  
VF80 ; "Repro monitor" and "Input monitor".  
Rec B  
Rec B  
Rec B  
Silence  
Rec C  
Rec C  
Silence  
Rec D  
Rec D  
"Repro monitor" means that the track playback sig-  
nal is monitored.  
Silence  
Silence  
Silence  
"Input monitor" means that the input source of the  
track is monitored. You can check the signal level for  
recording in this mode.  
Rec E  
Silence  
Input monitor is only available for tracks to be re-  
corded (on REC standby) or currently being recorded.  
Signal output from the recorder  
Signal input in the recorder  
Playback sound (Playback monitor)  
1 track  
2 track  
Playback sound (Playback monitor)  
Input signal (Input monitor)  
3 track  
4 track  
READY  
Input signal (Input monitor)  
READY  
Playback sound (Playback monitor)  
Playback sound (Playback monitor)  
Playback sound (Playback monitor)  
Playback sound (Playback monitor)  
5 track  
6 track  
7 track  
8 track  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Features of VF80  
Bar/Beat/Clk shows the musical position generated  
from the internal tempo map of the VF80 (including  
time signature and tempo).  
Trim  
It is important to set the analog input level appropri-  
ately when converting an analog input signal from  
[INPUT] A or B into a digital signal (A/D conversion).  
You can adjust the analog level using the [TRIM] con-  
trol. The [PEAK] indicator lights if the level is too high.  
The example below shows the current recorder posi-  
tion is at beat 1 of bar -2.  
This position (beat 1 of bar -2) corresponds to ABS 0  
and the following bar/beat numbers are determined  
according to the time signature and tempo settings.  
If the [TRIM] setting is not appropriate and the ana-  
log input level is too high (if the PEAK indicator lights),  
the signal will be converted into a distorted digital  
signal, resulting digital noise. You cannot eliminate  
this distortion/noise from the sound in the following  
stages. Therefore, be sure to adjust the level appro-  
priately using the [TRIM] knob not to light the [PEAK]  
indicator when receiving the loudest audio input sig-  
nal.  
Appropriate gain  
Excessive gain  
Clip level  
Beat 1 of bar -2 corresponds to ABS 0 as the default  
setting, however, you can change to set it between bar  
-9 and bar -2.  
MTC (MIDI Time Code) runs in sync with the ABS time.  
The MTC value (**h **m **s) corresponding to ABS 0  
can be set, which is called "MTC offset".  
Clip level  
If you set the MTC offset to 01h 00m 00s, the MTC will  
start from 01h 00m 00s, and at the ABS 00h 00m 00s  
position, the MTC value will be 02h 00m 00s  
The example below shows that the current position is  
at MTC 00h 59m 57s  
Time Base  
The term "Time base" frequently appears in this  
manual. The time base is used to show the location in  
the recorder, like the "tape counter" of conventional  
tape recorders.  
There are three types of time bases:  
1. ABS (Absolute time)  
2. Bar/Beat/Clk (Bar/Beat/Clock)  
3. MTC (MIDI Time Code)  
You can switch between these time bases by pressing  
the [TIME BASE SEL] key.  
The ABS shows the absolute time of each program and  
is striped from 00h 00m 00s (=ABS 0) to 23h 59m 59s  
when a program is created.  
The default MTC offset is 00h 59m 57s 00f 00sf. You  
can change the offset to any time value of 24-hour  
clock.  
The example below shows the current recorder posi-  
tion is at 00m (minute) 00s (second) 00f (frame).  
The hour digit appears only when the ABS time ex-  
ceeds 01h 00m 00s 00f.  
It is also possible to set the MTC offset by setting the  
MTC value corresponding to "beat 1 of bar 1" instead  
of "ABS 0".  
ABS 0 is the reference position for managing all the  
location and related to other time bases.  
The following diagram illustrates the relationship  
between the three time bases.  
ABS 0  
00M 00S  
00M 03S  
00M 06S  
.....  
.....  
.....  
ABS  
BAR/ /CLK  
MTC  
- 002BAR  
1
001BAR  
1
002BAR  
1
00H 59M 57S  
01H 00M 00S  
01H 00M 03S  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names and functions  
Names and Functions  
Top panel  
ST OUT  
INPUT A  
BAL  
FOOT SW  
PHONES  
INPUT B  
BAL  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F3  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
F FWD  
EDIT  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS 0  
LOCATE REC END  
Rear panel  
S/P DIF / DATA  
INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON  
OFF  
OUTPUT  
INPUT  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names and functions  
Top panel (Analog input/output section)  
2
4
6
8
9
10  
1
3
5
7
INPUT A  
BAL  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PHONES  
INPUT B  
BAL  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
12  
11  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
BOUNCE  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F3  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
5. [INPUT B/BAL] (Balanced) connector  
• Connects to the balanced output of an external sound  
source.  
1. [INPUT A/UNBAL] (Unbalanced) connector  
• Connectstotheunbalancedoutputofanexternalsound  
source.  
• Reference input level: -50 dBV to +2 dBV (approx. -48  
dBu to +4 dBu)  
• Reference input level: -50 dBV to +2 dBV  
• Connector type: phone jack  
• Connector type: XLR-3-31 type (pin #2 hot)  
• A phantom power (+48 V) can be supplied for using a  
condenser microphone by setting the [PHANTOM]  
switch on the rear panel to ON.  
• When the [INPUT B/UNBAL] connector is plugged, the  
input from this connector is interrupted.  
• When this connector is plugged, the input from the  
[INPUT A/BAL] connector is interrupted.  
2. [INPUT A/BAL] (Balanced) connector  
• Connects to the balanced output of an external sound  
source.  
• Reference input level: -50 dBV to +2 dBV (approx. -48  
dBu to +4 dBu)  
6. [INPUT B/TRIM] knob  
• Controls the gain according to the signal from [INPUT B].  
• You can adjust the gain to accept input signals between  
-50 dBV (MIC) and +2 dBV (LINE).  
• Connector type: XLR-3-31 type (pin #2 hot)  
• A phantom power (+48 V) can be supplied for using a  
condenser microphone by setting the [PHANTOM]  
switch on the rear panel to ON.  
• When the [INPUT A/UNBAL] connector is plugged, the  
input from this connector is interrupted.  
7. [PHONES] (Headphones) knob  
• Adjusts the level of headphones for monitoring.  
3. [INPUT A/TRIM] knob  
• Controls the gain according to the signal from [INPUT  
8. [PHONES] (Headphones) connector  
• Connects headphones for monitoring.  
• Connector type: TRS phone jack  
A].  
• You can adjust the gain to accept input signals between  
-50 dBV (MIC) and +2 dBV (LINE).  
9. [ST OUT L. R] (Stereo out) connector  
• Outputs the stereo (L and R) buss signal.  
• Connects to a master recorder, etc.  
• Reference output level: -10 dBV  
4. [INPUT B/UNBAL] (Unbalanced) connector  
• Connectstotheunbalancedoutputofanexternalsound  
source.  
• Connector type: phone jack  
• Reference input level: -50 dBV to +2 dBV  
• Connector type: phone jack  
• When this connector is plugged, the input from the  
[INPUT B/BAL] connector is interrupted.  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names and functions  
10. [FOOT SW] (Foot switch) connector  
• Connects to an optional foot switch (Model 8051) for  
punch in/out operation.  
11. [PEAK] indicators  
• Each indicator lights up when the corresponding input  
signal reaches the clipping level.  
• Connector type: phone jack  
• Set the [TRIM] knob properly not to light the indicator.  
<Caution>  
12. [CH ON/OFF] keys  
• Each key is used to turn on and off of the  
Do not power on the machine with non-specified foot  
SW connected to the foot SW jack. When powering on  
the machine with non-specified foot SW (latch type foot  
SW, etc.) connected to the foot SW jack, there is a case  
that the machine does not correctly boot up with “No  
Drive!” alter message. In such a case, power off the  
machine once, disconnect the foot SW and then power  
back on.  
corresponding channel. When on, the key illuminates.  
See the following description for details about how to use  
each element.  
Top panel (Mixer section)  
15  
14  
18  
16  
20  
21  
17  
19  
INPUT A  
BAL  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PHONES  
INPUT B  
BAL  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
SCENE SCENE SEQ.  
TRACK  
EDIT  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
BOUNCE  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
22  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
13  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F3  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
24  
23  
13. [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys  
14. [BOUNCE] key  
• While stopped, each key is used to change the track  
status among OFF, PLAY and REC (READY).  
Duringplayback, pressingthekeyswitchesbetweenOFF  
and PLAY.  
• Turns the bounce mode on or off.  
When on (the key lights), tracks 7-8 are automatically  
armed for recording, allowing track 1 through 5 signals  
to bounce to track 7 and 8.  
During recording, you cannot change the track status.  
• When you view or edit mixer parameters such as pan  
and EQ in the "Mix parameter edit" mode (described  
later), you can select the target track by pressing the  
corresponding [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key.  
• The illumination of each key shows the track status as  
follows.  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
enters the “REC EFFECT” mode, in which rerecording a  
recorded track with applying the “insert effect” is  
possible. While the “REC EFFECT” mode is active, the  
[BOUNCE] key flashes in red. To exit the “REC EFFECT”  
mode, press the [BOUNCE] key again.  
* flashing in red: the track is in REC READY.  
* lighting in red: the track is being recorded.  
* lighting in green: the track can be played back.  
* not lighting (off): the track is muted.  
15. [MIX PARAMETER-PAN] key  
• When viewing or editing the pan pot setting, press this  
key.  
• Select the track to be viewed or edited by pressing the  
corresponding [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names and functions  
16. [MIX PARAMETER-EQ] key  
20. [2TRK MODE-TRAINING] key  
• Turns on or off the "Training mode" in which only tracks  
7-8 are played back. When the mode is active, the key  
lights up.  
• When viewing or editing the EQ setting, press this key.  
• Select the track to be viewed or edited by pressing the  
corresponding [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key.  
17. [MIX PARAMETER-SCENE / FADER] key  
• When storing, recalling or deleting a scene memory,  
press this key.  
• To view track fader positions, press this key while de  
pressing the [SHIFT] key.  
21. [2TRK MODE-MASTERING] key  
• Turns on or off the "Mastering mode" in which tracks  
7-8 are played back with sound processing (the EQ,  
reverb and compressor). When the mode is active, the  
key lights up.  
18. [MIX PARAMETER-EFFECT / ON/OFF] key  
• When selecting the internal DSP effects, adjusting the  
effect send levels, selecting pre or post of the effect send,  
or setting effect parameters, press this key.  
22. [STATUS/SEL-MASTER] key  
• Turns on or off the master channel.  
• Also used to select the track for the mix parameter edit.  
• Select the track to be viewed or edited by pressing the  
corresponding [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key.  
23. [MASTER] fader  
• Adjusts the output levels of the stereo L/R busses.  
19. [MIX PARAMETER-SCENE SEQ. / MAP] key  
• Turns on or off the scene sequence mode.  
• When editing the scene sequence map, press this key  
while depressing the [SHIFT] key.  
24.Track faders  
• Adjusts the playback levels of the tracks 1 through 6 and  
7-8.  
Top panel (Recorder/Display section)  
27  
28  
25  
26  
INPUT A  
BAL  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PHONES  
INPUT B  
BAL  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
BOUNCE  
29  
30  
31  
32  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
33  
ENTER  
/YES  
0
34  
35  
36  
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F3  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
PITCH  
LOOP  
EDIT  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
48  
37  
47 46 4541 40 39 38  
44 43  
42  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names and functions  
35. [LOCATE | / MARK] key  
25. [TRACK EDIT / PGM] key  
• Each press of this key locates the previous mark point.  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
stores the current position in the mark map.  
• When editing audio of tracks such as copy/paste, etc.,  
press this key.  
There are four audio editing functions.  
a. copy  
b. move  
c. erase  
d. track exchange  
36. [LOCATE | / DELETE] key  
• Each press of this key locates the next mark point.  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
delete the current mark point directly.  
• Pressing this key while depressing the [SHIFT] key  
allows you to carry out the following program-related  
functions.  
37. [F FWD ] key  
• Pressing this key while stopped fast-forwards the  
a. creating a new program  
position at 30x speed.  
b. selecting a program  
• Pressing this key during playback moves forward the  
position at 3x speed with audible cue.  
c. editing a program title  
d. deleting a program  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [STOP] key  
executes the "LOCATE REC END" function (locates the  
last recording position of the current program).  
26. [CURSOR  
• Used to move the edit point in edit or setup mode.  
/
/
/
] keys  
38. [REWIND ] key  
• Pressing this key while stopped rewinds the position at  
27. LCD (Liquid Crystal Display)  
• Displays the recorder or mixer status or parameters.  
30x speed.  
• Pressing this key during playback moves backward the  
position at 3x speed with audible cue.  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [STOP] key  
executes the "LOCATE ABS 0" function (locates the  
beginning of the current program).  
28. Contrast adjusting knob  
• Adjusts the LCD contrast.  
Turning the knob clockwise makes the contrast higher,  
while turning it counterclockwise makes it lower.  
29. [ACCESS] indicator  
• Lights up while the internal hard disk drive or external  
39. [PLAY] key  
• Pressing this key starts the recorder playback.  
• Pressing the [RECORD] key while holding down this key  
(or pressing this key while holding down the [RECORD]  
key)startsrecordingofthearmed(RECREADY)track(s).  
• Pressing this key alone during recording punches out  
(releases recording).  
backup SCSI device is writing or reading data.  
<Caution>  
Do not turn off the VF80 power while this indicator  
lights. Data recorded in the disk may be erased.  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [STOP] key  
locates the last playback position.  
30. [PHANTOM] indicator  
• Lights up when the phantom power is supplied.  
You can switch the phantom power on or off by the  
[PHANTOM] switch on the rear panel.  
40. [STOP] key  
• Pressing this key during playback, recording, fast-  
forward or rewinding stops the recorder running.  
• Also used to cancel or interrupt SETUP menu settings  
or audio editing functions such as Copy and Paste.  
• Pressing the [F FWD] or [REWIND] key while holding  
down this key executes the "LOCATE REC END" or  
"LOCATE ABS 0" function.  
31. [EXIT/NO / EJECT] key  
• Used to cancel or interrupt SETUP menu settings or  
audio editing functions such as Copy and Paste.  
The opposite of the [ENTER/YES] key.  
• Pressing the [PLAY] key while holding down this key  
locates the last playback position.  
• Pressing the [RECORD] key while holding down this key  
locates the last recording position.  
32. [ENTER/YES] key  
• Used to execute SETUP menu settings or audio editing  
functions such as Copy and Paste. The opposite of the  
[EXIT/NO / EJECT] key.  
41. [RECORD] key  
33. [JOG / SHUTTLE] dial  
• Pressing the [PLAY] key while holding down this key (or  
pressing this key while holding down the [PLAY] key)  
starts recording of the armed (REC READY) track(s).  
• Pressing this key alone switches the monitor of the  
armed track (s) to Input monitor (the [RECORD] key  
flashes).  
• When the [WAVE FORM SCRUB] key is illuminated, after  
pressing any of the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys,  
rotating this dial scrubs audio digitally with no pitch  
change for both forward and backward directions.  
• Used to change a parameter value in the edit mode.  
• Pressing this dial while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
moves the position forward or backward at 1x to 64x  
speed depending on the rotating direction and degree.  
Pressing this key again switches the monitor back to  
Repro monitor.  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [STOP] key  
locates the last recording position.  
34. [SHIFT] key  
• Used to activate the second (shifted) functions of keys  
and a dial. Each shifted function is labeled in a while-  
line boxes on the panel.  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names and functions  
42. [WAVE FORM SCRUB] key  
• Pressing this key enters the scrub mode. In the scrub  
mode, you can scrub audio forward or backward  
digitally.  
In the example below, pressing the [SETUP / F1]  
key, [TIME BASE SEL / F2] key or [UNDO/REDO / F3]  
key executes "RECALL", "STORE" or "DELETE" re-  
spectively.  
43. [VARI PITCH / EDIT] key  
• Pressing this key switches between On and Off of the vari  
pitch (vari-speed playback/recording) function.  
When the function is active, this key is illuminated.  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
makes you ready to edit the pitch value via the screen.  
44. [LOOP / EDIT] key  
• PressingthiskeyswitchesbetweenOnandOffoftheloop  
mode. When the mode is active, this key is illuminated.  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
makesyoureadytoedittheloopparameters(Startpoint  
and End point) via the screen.  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Recalling a scene  
Deleting a scene  
Storing a scene  
45. [AUTO PUNCH I/O / EDIT] key  
TIMEBASE  
SEL  
SETUP  
F1  
UNDO / REDO  
F3  
• PressingthiskeyswitchesbetweenOnandOffoftheauto  
punch mode. When the mode is active, this key is  
illuminated.  
F2  
• Pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
makes you ready to edit the auto punch parameters (In  
point and Out point) via the screen.  
46. [TIME BASE SEL / F2] key  
• Pressing this key switches the time base shown on the  
SHIFT  
screen among the following.  
a. ABS (absolute time):  
Absolute time from 00h00m00s to 23h59m59s.  
b. Bar/Beat/Clk (Bar/Beat/Clock):  
Bar/Beat/Clock according to the time signature and  
tempo information set in the internal tempo map.  
c. MTC (MIDITime Code)  
MTC with or without an offset to the ABS time.  
• When a key icon is shown above "F2" on the screen,  
pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
executes the function directly.  
47. [SETUP / F1] key  
• Pressing this key enters the setup mode for editing/  
setting the initial setting parameters of recorder and  
mixer.  
• When a key icon is shown above "F1" on the screen,  
pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
executes the function directly.  
48. [UNDO/REDO / F3] key  
• Pressing this key cancels the operation for the audio  
editing (Copy, Paste, etc.), auto punch in/out or  
recording, and returns to the previous condition.  
This is the "undo" function.  
• Pressing this key again returns to the condition before  
carrying out the "undo" function. This is the "redo"  
function.  
• When a key icon is shown above "F3" on the screen,  
pressing this key while holding down the [SHIFT] key  
executes the function directly.  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names and functions  
Rear panel  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF / DATA  
OUTPUT INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
INPUT  
54 55  
49  
51 52 53  
50  
53. [S/P DIF / DATA INPUT] connector  
• Accepts the S/P DIF digital signal. Used to connect to the  
coaxial (S/P DIF) digital output of an external digital  
device. If the external device only provides the optical  
digital output, use the Fostex COP-1 coaxial/optical  
converter.  
49. [AC IN] connector  
• Connects the supplied AC power cord. Make sure that  
the voltage of your AC outlet matches the specified  
voltage.  
50. [POWER] switch  
• Turns on or off the power of the unit.  
• Connector: RCA pin jack  
54. [MIDI OUTPUT] connector  
• Connects to the MIDI IN connector of an external MIDI  
device.  
• Mainly transmits MIDI information for synchronization  
such as MTC (MIDI Time Code) and MIDI clock with song  
position pointer.  
51. [PHANTOM] ON/OFF switch  
• When the switch is set to ON, the phantom power is  
supplied to the condenser microphone(s) connected to  
the[INPUTA/BAL] and/orthe[INPUTB/BAL] connector(s).  
52. [S/P DIF / DATA OUTPUT] connector  
• Outputs the S/P DIF digital signal. Used to connect to  
the coaxial (S/P DIF) digital input of an external digital  
device.  
If the external device only provides the optical digital  
input, use the Fostex COP-1 coaxial/optical converter.  
• Connector: RCA pin jack  
• Connector: DIN 5-pin type  
55. [MIDI INPUT] connector  
• Connects to the MIDI OUT connector of an external MIDI  
device.  
• Mainly receives MIDI control information such as MMC  
(MIDI Machine Control).  
• Connector: DIN 5-pin type  
See an appropriate section for the detailed information of  
each operation or function.  
Side panel  
56  
56. Slot for the optional CD-RW drive  
• You can install the Model CD-1A optional CD-RW drive  
in this slot.  
• See page 134 for details about how to install the optional  
CD-RW drive.  
If you want to know details about the option, contact  
your dealer or a Fostex sales office.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About the hard disk storage device  
About the hard disk storage device  
The VF80 is complete with a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk (storage device) which is formatted in the Master  
8 mode. Therefore, there is no need to newly assemble a hard disk or to format the hard disk.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key whileIDEis flashed.  
The menu to select the format type appears.  
4
Reformatting the hard disk  
The display will appear as follows, according to the  
previous format type. ****” represents the name of the  
drive.  
This section describes how to reformat the hard disk.  
The VF80 adopts a “FDMS-3 (Fostex Disk Management  
System-3)” format which is a Fostex exclusive format.  
24 additional tracks can be used in addition to  
recording and playing 8-tracks of uncompressed  
44.1kHz/16 bit high quality sound.  
The hard disk formatted in the “Standard” type upon  
newly formatting the hard disk will show “Standard” and  
Erase”. The hard disk formatted in the “Quick” type  
upon newly formatting the hard disk will show  
Standard” and “Quick”. The user can select one.  
<Precaution>  
Note that, when you reformat your hard disk, you will  
erase all data saved or recorded on the hard disk, as well  
as all the settings made. Reformatting your hard disk  
restore the VF80 back to the default setting.  
Always make a point to check that there is no data that  
you need remaining on the hard disk prior to  
reformatting.  
Flashing  
1
2
Turn ON theVF80.  
or  
Press the [SETUP] key.  
The system will go to the SETUP mode.  
The select display of the SETUP menu appears. (The  
highlight indicates the menu that is currently selected.)  
Flashing  
The hard disk is formatted with the access time  
of the unit sectors, while judging whether the  
sectors are good or bad. The formatting time  
tends to be longer with this type, however, the  
reliability is better.  
Turn the [JOG] dial to highlight the“Disk Formatmenu  
title, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
IDE” indicates the current drive.  
3
“Standard”  
Therefore,itisrecommendedthatthisdefault  
format type is selected under normal  
conditions.  
This choice is only available when a hard disk  
previously formatted in the “Standard” type is  
being reformatted. With this format, the  
“Erase”  
Standard” type is maintained, while all data on  
the hard disk are erased. The formatting time is  
shorter than the time required to format a  
Standard” type.  
This is a quick formatting procedure in which all  
hard disk sectors are considered to be good  
sectors. The formatting time is fast, however, the  
procedure cannot discover bad sectors.  
“Quick”  
Flashing  
Therefore, itisrecommendedthatthisformattype  
is only used when formatting a new hard disk that  
Fostex has already confirmed to operate  
normally.  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abouttheharddiskstoragedevice  
Selecttheformattypewiththe[CURSOR / ]key. Then  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
5
Replacing a hard disk  
The format type selected is set and “Sure?” flashes.  
The user can immediately start recording with the  
VF80. Note that the current hard disk can also be  
replaced with another model for use with the VF80.  
(However, please only use hard disks that Fostex  
recommends.)  
<Operation Confirmed HD List for theVF80>  
The updated information on the operation-  
confirmed HD and backup media for VF80 is  
mentioned in the following Fostex international  
web site.  
Flashing  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while the [RECORD] key  
6
is depressed.  
If the “Standard” format is selected and executed, the  
formatting process takes place while showing the  
progress of the good sectors (Good ***MB) on the disk,  
bad sectors on the disk (Bad ***MB) and remainder  
(Remain ***MB).  
<http: // www. fostex.co.jp/int/index.htm>  
For those who are unable to check our web site,  
please contact the Fostex distributor in your  
territory.  
Nothing can be done during the formatting process.  
Please wait for a while until the process is completed.  
<Warning>  
This section describes the procedures to replace the hard  
disk. However, we recommended that the customer ask  
the Fostex Customer Service Department to replace the  
VF80 hard disk. Note that the product is not warranted  
for any malfunctions that may occur after the customer  
replaces the hard disk on their own. Also note that Fostex  
will not be held liable for any accidents that may occur  
during the replacement process or any hard disk  
damages, if the customer decides to replace their own  
hard disk on their own.  
When the hard disk is successfully formatted  
(formatting completed), the number of sectors and  
noncontiguous sectors are shown after formatted, then  
Completed!” lights up. Formatting is completed  
instantaneously if either “Erase” or “Quick” is selected  
and executed.  
For this reason, the “Completed!” message lights up  
without showing the progress status while formatting  
is taking place.  
<Precautions Upon Replacement>  
• Always turn OFF the power of the VF80 and unplug the  
power plug from the electric outlet when replacing the  
hard disk.  
• Always place the hard disk on a flat and stable platform  
during the replacement process. Place a soft cloth  
under the unit to protect the product from scratching.  
Gloves are recommended to prevent any hand injuries.  
<Precautions Upon Handling the Hard Disk>  
• A hard disk is an extremely sensitive precision device.  
Never expose the hard disk to “strong shocks” when  
replacing, assembling or handling. Never leave the  
hard disk by a device that generates strong magnetic  
fields.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key) to escape from  
7
• Always set the DIP switch and Jumper of the newly  
assembled hard disk to the “Cable Select” setting.  
The hard disk will not operate normally if the setting  
is set to “Slave” or “Master” when the hard disk is  
assembled. Refer to the User’s Manual of the hard disk  
for more details on the DIP switch and Jumper settings.  
the SETUP mode.  
The Normal Screen appears indicating the beginning of  
the program (P01) that is automatically created after  
formatting the hard disk.  
• Note that the connector of some hard disks may be stiff,  
and thus make it difficult or impossible to insert or  
connect. Never apply excessive force to insert the  
connector in such case. Always make a point to gently  
insert the connector. Failure to do so may result in  
unexpected injuries or damage the hard disk.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About the hard disk storage device  
Unscrew the four screws from the bottom of the main  
unit that are fixing the panel.  
After disconnecting the cables, remove the panel that  
is fixing the hard disk.  
1
4
Unscrew the four screws with a screwdriver, as shown  
in the Figure.  
2
1
3
4
1
2
Turnoverthepanelthattheharddiskisfixedaccording  
to the instructions shown in the figure below.  
Note that hard disk cables will be connected.  
Be careful not to apply excessive force when turning  
over the panel.  
2
3
4
Fix a new hard disk to the panel in the reverse order of  
removing the hard disk as performed earlier. Connect  
the cables. Then house the hard disk at the bottom of  
5
the main unit.  
Followthe<Precautions> describedearlier, andproperly  
assemble the parts.  
Remove the two cable connectors that are connected  
to the hard disk.  
Gently hold the connector and slowly pull out.  
3
When the new hard disk is successfully assembled,  
go to the next section. Now, format the unformatted  
hard disk.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abouttheharddiskstoragedevice  
Formatting the Hard disk  
Carefully follow the instructions below to newly  
format the hard disk properly.  
Flashing  
Turn ON theVF80 after plugging the power cable in the  
1
electric outlet.  
The VF80 will startup. Unformat!” will appear on the  
LCD. The menu will automatically go to the SETUP  
mode.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while the [RECORD] key  
is depressed.  
The formatting process is started. The formatting  
process will take some time.  
When the formatting is successfully completed,  
Completed!” will light up on the display.  
5
6
The display showing the “Disk Format” menu appears.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key) to escape from  
the SETUP mode.  
The Normal Screen appears indicating the beginning  
of the program (P01) that is automatically created after  
formatting the hard disk.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
2
The drive selection display appears.  
IDE” will be flashed.  
Flashing  
<Normal Screen>  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key where theIDEis flashed.  
3
The menu to select the format type appears.  
****” represents the name of the drive.  
<CAUTION>  
Either the “Standard” or “Quick” format type can  
be selected. However, make sure that the  
“Standard” format type is selected when  
formatting a newly installed hard disk.  
Flashing  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key where theStandardis  
4
flashed.  
The format type selected is set and “Sure?” flashes.  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Basic Recording and Playback  
This chapter describes the basics of recording and playback audio using the VF80.  
Before carrying out recording/playback, read “About a demonstration song!”, “Connections of exter-  
nal equipment”, “Preliminary knowledge” and “LCD”.  
About a demonstration song!  
Your VF80 may have a demonstration song on program 1 (P01) when shipped (note that some VF80  
units may not have a demonstration song, depending on the production). Please check whether a  
demonstration song is recorded or not on your unit according the following manner.  
<To check whether a demonstration song is recorded or not>  
After turning on the unit and booting up program 1, press the [PLAY] key to start playback.  
• If the level meters move:  
• If the level meters do not move:  
A demonstration song is recorded.  
Title of the recorded demonstration song will be  
indicated for the program title.  
No demonstration song is recorded.  
Temporary title such as "#0001" will be indicated  
for the program title.  
If a demonstration song is recorded, you can listen to the song any time by playing back program  
1 (see page 28 for details about how to play back a program).  
Note that you cannot record a new material on program 1 if a demonstration song is recorded on  
program 1. Therefore, before starting recording for the first time, you must carry out any of the  
following operations.  
Note: You can start recording without the need for carrying out any of the following operations if no  
demonstration song is recorded on your unit.  
If you wish to start recording while keeping the demonstration song  
Create a new program.  
The newly created program is not record-prohibited, so you can record a material onto it.  
See page “61” for details about how to create a new program.  
If you wish to record a material on program 1 (overwriting the demonstration song)  
Set "Rec Protect" menu in the setup mode to "Off".  
Now you can overwrite the demonstration song on program 1 by a new material.  
See page “129” for details about how to make the record-protect setting to "Off".  
If you wish to record a material onto program 1 after deleting the demonstration song  
Delete program 1.  
After deleting program 1, a new blank "program 1" is automatically created onto which you can  
record a new material.  
See page “62” for details about how to delete a program.  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Connections of external equipment  
You can connect various sound sources and external devices to the input and output connectors of the  
VF80 as shown in the example below. When making connection, make sure that the [MASTER] fader  
is set to the lowest (“”) position and the [PHONES] knob to the left most (“MIN”) position. Otherwise,  
your speakers or headphones may damage by the audio noise generated when connecting cables.  
Headphones  
Amplifier + Speakers etc.  
Microphones (Dynamic  
or condenser type)  
Foot switch (mode 8051)  
PHS  
ST OUT  
FW  
<Note>  
L
You cannot use both the [BAL] and  
[UNBAL] connectors on INPUT A and  
INPUTBsimultaneously. Pluggingthe  
[UNBAL] connector disconnects the  
[BAL] connector.  
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
Top panel  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
TRIM  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
REC EFF  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
/OFF  
N/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
<Note>  
Do not power on the machine with non-speci-  
fied foot SW connected to the foot SW jack.  
When powering on the machine with non-  
specified foot SW (latch type foot SW, etc.)  
connected to the foot SW jack, there is a case  
that the machine does not correctly boot up  
with “No Drive!” alert message. In such a case,  
power off the machine once, disconnect the  
foot SW and then power back on.  
Guitar processor  
Electric guitar  
Electric bass  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF  
OUTPUT  
/
DATA  
INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
INPUT  
Rear panel  
AC outlet  
Digital equipment (CD, MD, DAT etc.)  
Sequencer  
PC w/sequence software  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Switching the time base  
Each press of the [TIME BASE SEL] key cycles the time  
base of the Normal screen between “ABS”, “BAR/BEAT/  
CLK” and “MTC”.  
LCD  
This section describes major contents on the LCD  
display and their operations.  
Display when turning on the power  
When turning on the power of the VF80 on which a  
formatted hard disk is installed, the unit starts up and  
Initial..” and “version number” appears on the LCD  
display, followedbyCurrentDr”, “IDE”, “harddiskname  
(momentarily)” and “record mode (Standard or  
Quick)”. Then the unit gets ready at the beginning  
(ABS 0) of the program which was selected when the  
power was turned off last time. The current position  
is shown by the time base previously selected.  
The display that appears when the unit gets ready is  
call “Normal screen”. The Normal screen shows the fol-  
lowing items.  
Normal screen with ABS time base  
Normal screen with BAR/BEAT/CLK time base  
Screen example while starting up  
Normal screen with MTC time base  
3
4
Normal screen  
“Disk remain” indication  
You can check the disk remaining space which shows  
the “recordable space left on the current disk”.  
The disk remaining space (REM) is shown during “Rec  
ready” or “Recording”, in “time” when the remaining  
time is less than 100 hours, or in “MB (Megabyte)” of  
the remaining space when it exceeds 100 hours.  
Note that the remaining time is shown as the record-  
able time when you record onto a single track.  
You can calculate the recordable time for recording  
onto8tracksbydividingthedisplayedremainingtime  
by 8.  
2
1
5
6
1. Scene number & name  
With the initial setting, “S00: Initial Mix” appears.  
2. Program number & name  
With the initial setting, “P01: #0001” (#0001 is a tentative  
name) appears.  
3. Mark number & name  
With the initial setting, “00: ABS 0” appears, showing that  
thecurrentlocationisatthebeginningoftheprogram. When  
the recorder starts running, “:” between the number and  
name is replaced with “+”.  
Remaining time displayed in time  
4.Time base  
With the initial setting, the ABS time base is selected.  
You can change the time base by using the [TIME BASE SEL]  
key (see the next section).  
5. Level meters forTracks 1 through 8  
Remaining time displayed in MB  
6. Master level meters for the Stereo output (L, R)  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Preliminary knowledge  
• Inputs and tracks  
You can record onto adjacent two tracks (Tracks 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, or 7-8) or a mono track (one of Tracks 1 through  
6). You cannot select another combination.  
The input signal from INPUT A is fed to odd tracks (1, 3, 5 and 7), while the input signal from INPUT B is fed to  
even tracks (2, 4, 6 and 8). Because each input signal is directly fed to appropriate tracks, you cannot tailor the  
signal when recording. However, you can add reverb or equalize the sound during mixdown, or rerecord a track  
sound later with applying a distortion-type effect.  
PEAK  
TRACK STATUS  
/ TRACK SEL  
HARD DISK  
TRACK 1  
CH ON/OFF  
BALANCE  
INPUT A  
TRIM  
TRACK 2  
TRACK 3  
TRACK 4  
TRACK 5  
UNBALANCE  
TRACK 6  
TRACK 7  
TRACK 8  
CH ON/OFF  
BALANCE  
INPUT B  
TRIM  
PEAK  
UNBALANCE  
<Balanced (XLR) and unbalanced (phone) input connectors>  
Both the balanced and unbalanced input connectors are provided for INPUT A and INPUT B, allowing connec-  
tion of balanced and unbalanced devices. In addition, the phantom (DC 48 V) power can be supplied to the  
balanced XLR inputs, so you can use condenser microphones that need the phantom power (see the following  
section about how to use condenser microphones).  
<Note>  
You cannot use both the balanced and unbalanced inputs simultaneously.  
When plugging the unbalanced (phone) input connector, the balanced (XLR) input connector is disconnected.  
• How to use condenser microphones  
When connecting a condenser microphone that needs the phantom power, set the [PHANTOM] switch on the rear  
panel to “ON”. Read the following notes carefully before using the phantom power.  
<Notes for using the phantom power>  
• Be sure to keep the following notes.  
* When connecting a condenser microphone to the balanced input  
connector of the VF80, check whether or not the microphone needs  
the phantom power (+48 V).  
* Switch the [PHANTOM] switch to ON after connecting a microphone.  
* When switching the [PHANTOM] switch, or when plugging or  
unplugging a microphone, mute the VF80 output signals.  
* When connecting a dynamic microphone to the balanced input  
connector, set the [PHANTOM] switch to OFF. Otherwise, the  
microphone may damage.  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF  
OUTPUT  
/
DATA  
INPUT  
[PHANTOM]switch  
You cannot use the phantom power for following microphones.  
* microphones with the unbalanced output  
* high impedance microphones  
* microphones with the XLR connectors that leaks a signal between  
pin #2 and pin #1 or pin #3 and pin #1  
* microphones with the center tapout type ground such as old-  
fashioned ribbon microphones  
<Important notes for on/off switching>  
Note that the VF80 power must be ON when  
changing the [PHANTOM] switch setting.  
Also note that the [PHANTOM] switch should be  
set to “OFF” after using the phantom power.  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Basic recording (recording onto a single track)  
At first, let’s record a single sound source onto a single track to know the basic recording procedure of the VF80  
There are 8 recording tracks (Tracks 1 through 8) and you can record onto any desired track(s).  
In the following example, we are going to record an electric guitar (with an effect unit) onto Track 1.  
Before starting, set all the track faders (1 through 6 and 7-8) and the master fader to the lowest position (-), and  
the [TRIM] knob to the left most position (LINE).  
6
2
INPUT  
BAL  
A
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PHES  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
L
R
1
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
6
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
4
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F3  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
8
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
PITCH  
LOOP  
EDIT  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
11  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
4
5
9
7 10  
Raise both the track 1 fader and master fader to0po-  
sition.  
4
Preparation for recording  
This is preparation for monitoring sound. If both of  
these faders are set at the minimum position, no sound  
can be monitored.  
Connect the [INPUT A] UNBAL jack to the output of the  
effect unit whose input is connected to a guitar.  
To record onto Track 1, 3, 5 or 7, use INPUT A.  
1
<Note>  
Connect the [PHONES] jack to headphones for moni-  
toring.  
2
3
The track 1 fader can be used for adjusting the moni-  
tor level without affecting the recording level. To  
adjust the recording level, use the [TRIM] knob of  
INPUT A.  
Press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key ofTrack  
1.  
The key lighting in green changes to flashing in red,  
showing Track 1 is now armed. (The “Remain” time is  
shown on the screen.)  
The [CH ON/OFF] key of INPUT A automatically lights.  
In this condition, by pressing the [CH ON/OFF] key of IN-  
PUT A, INPUT A can be muted.  
Press the [RECORD] key.  
The key starts flashing in red, while Track 1 (which is  
armed) changes to the input monitor mode.  
5
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
To stop recording, press the [STOP] key.  
After showing “PleaseWait!”, the LCD returns to the Nor-  
mal screen.  
Use the [TRIM] knob of INPUT A while playing the gui-  
tar to get proper gain.  
9
6
Set the gain at maximum within the range in which the  
[PEAK] indicator does not turn on when playing the  
guitar at the loudest volume.  
You can monitor both the input level of Track 1 and the  
stereo (L & R) output level from the bar-graph meters  
on the screen.  
<Unarming a track>  
To unarm a track, press the flashing [TRACK STA-  
TUS/TRACK SEL] key twice. The key changes to light  
in green.  
Now you have recorded a sound source onto a track.  
Playback  
Pressthe[REWIND]keywhileholdingdownthe[STOP]  
10  
key to locateABS 0”.  
<Note>  
Press the [PLAY] key to start playback.  
11  
Set the gain not to light the [PEAK] indicator when  
playing the guitar at the loudest volume.  
When the [PEAK] indicator lights, the input level is  
too high and the sound may be distorted or digital  
noise may be generated.  
You can control the playback level by the track 1 fader.  
If you find that the recording was not successfully made,  
use the undo/redo function and try recording again.  
<Track muting >  
Theplaybacklevelofeachrecordedtrackcanbecon-  
trolled using the corresponding track fader.  
You can mute the playback track by pressing the cor-  
responding [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key except  
in the mix parameter edit mode.  
In the condition above, if you turn the [PHONES] knob  
clockwise, you can monitor the sound from the head-  
phones.  
<Warning!>  
Becarefulnottoexcessivelyraisethe[PHONE] volume.  
Prolonged exposure to loud sounds may have an  
adverse effect on hearing.  
Undo/Redo  
After finishing a recording, pressing the [UNDO/  
REDO] key returns to the condition just before re-  
cording (Undo).  
Recording  
If you press the [UNDO/REDO] key again, you can  
cancel the Undo operation and return back to the  
condition after recording.  
Pressthe[REWIND]keywhileholdingdownthe[STOP]  
key to locateABS 0”.  
If the current recorder position is “ABS 0”, you can skip  
the operation above.  
7
8
[UNDO/REDO] key  
Pressthe[PLAY]keywhileholdingdownthe[RECORD]  
key to start recording.  
The [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key of Track 1 and the  
[RECORD] key light on, showing the VF80 is now record-  
ing.  
TIMEBASE  
SETUP  
F1  
UNDO REDO  
/
SEL  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
VARI  
PUNCH I/O  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
The VF80 uses the direct recording method. In this  
method,a digital signal just after the A/D conversion is  
directly recorded onto a track, without being routed to  
extra algorithms such as EQ.  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
You can add reverb or equalize the sound during  
mixdown.  
In addition, the insert effect function allows rerecord-  
ing a track sound with applying a distortion-type effect  
later. Seeusing the insert effecton page 83.  
<Note>  
The undo/redo function is available to any recording,  
however, if you carry out any of the following operations  
after recording, you cannot use the undo/redo function.  
Therefore, if you are not satisfied with the recording,  
press the [UNDO/REDO] key immediately to undo the  
recording and make recording again.  
When the recorder starts running, the mark number and name  
shown on the top line of the screen changes as below, showing  
that the current position is ahead of “ABS 0” point.  
* Making a new recording  
* Making a new editing (copy, move, erase, auto punch  
in/out, etc.)  
* Turning off the power  
* Executing program select, rename, and deleting  
* Executing drive selection  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Basic recording (recording onto two tracks)  
After recording onto track 1 as described in the previous section, let’s make recording of a stereo sound source  
onto tracks 3 and 4.  
Stereo source  
1
INPUT A  
BAL  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PNES  
INPUT B  
BAL  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
5
2
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F3  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
3
LOCATE  
7
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
10  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
7
3
4
8
6 9  
Press the [RECORD] key.  
4
5
Preparation for recording  
The [RECORD] key starts flashing in red, while Tracks 3  
and 4 (which are armed) changes to the input monitor  
mode.  
Connect the [INPUT A] UNBAL and [INPUT B] UNBAL  
jacks to the L and R outputs of the stereo source re-  
spectively.  
1
2
Use the [TRIM] knobs of INPUT A and B while playing  
the stereo source to get proper gain.  
Press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys ofTracks  
3 and 4.  
Set the gain at maximum within the range in which the  
[PEAK] indicator does not turn on.  
You can monitor both the input level of Tracks 3 and 4  
from the bar-graph meters on the screen.  
The keys lighting in green change to flashing in red,  
showing Tracks 3 and 4 are now armed. (The “Remain”  
time is shown on the screen.)  
The [CH ON/OFF] keys of INPUT A and B automatically  
light in green.  
Raise the faders of tracks 3 and 4 and [MASTER] fader  
to0position.  
3
This is preparation for monitoring sound. If both of  
these faders are set at the minimum position, no sound  
can be monitored.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
<Note>  
Playback  
Set the gain not to light the [PEAK] indicator.  
When the [PEAK] indicator lights, the input level is  
too high and the sound may be distorted or digital  
noise may be generated.  
Locate the desired position (time) for playback.  
9
Press the [PLAY] key to start playback.  
You can control track playback levels by using the cor-  
responding track faders.  
10  
In the condition above, if you turn the [PHONES] knob  
clockwise, you can monitor the sound from the head-  
phones.  
Ifyoufindthattherecordingwasnotsuccessfullymade,  
use the undo/redo function and try recording again.  
<Warning!>  
Be careful not to excessively raise the [PHONE] vol-  
ume. Prolonged exposure to loud sounds may have  
an adverse effect on hearing.  
<Track muting>  
Theplaybacklevelofeachrecordedtrackcanbecon-  
trolled using the corresponding track fader.  
You can mute the playback tracks by pressing the  
corresponding [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys  
except in the mix parameter edit mode.  
Recording  
Locate the start position (time) for recording.  
6
7
<How to use recording tracks effectively>  
The VF80 has 8 recordable tracks.  
Pressthe[PLAY]keywhileholdingdownthe[RECORD]  
key to start recording.  
If you record materials onto all 8 tracks according  
to the procedures described in “Basic recording”,  
you cannot record further materials.  
To record more materials, you can use the “track  
bounce” technique to save tracks as follows:  
The [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys of Tracks 3 and 4,  
as well as the [RECORD] key light on, showing the VF80  
is now recording.  
You can see the meter for Track 1 also moving. By rais-  
ing the Track 1 fader, you can make overdubbing onto  
tracks 3 and 4 while listening to playback of track 1.  
1. Record materials onto tracks 1 through 6.  
2. Mix the signals recorded on tracks 1 through  
6andrecordthemixedsignalontotracks7and  
8.  
Then tracks 1 through 6 can be used to record  
other materials.  
This is the basic technique used for Multitrackers.  
We recommend that tracks 7 and 8 are basically  
used as the destination tracks of “track bounce”  
from tracks 1 through 6.  
SeeAdvancedOperationfordetailsaboutthetrack  
bounce technique.  
When the recorder starts running, the mark number  
and name shown on the top line of the screen changes  
as below, showing that the current position is ahead  
of “ABS 0” point.  
In addition, tracks 7 and 8 play an important role  
in “training mode” and “mastering mode” described  
later in “Advanced functions”.  
The VF80 also provides the “track exchange” func-  
tion which allows you to keep recordable tracks.  
The VF80 has 16 additional tracks for each pro-  
gram, in addition to 8 recordable (and playable)  
real tracks (1 through 8). The “track exchange”  
function allows you to exchange a real track and  
an additional track, making the real track empty.  
To stop recording, press the [STOP] key.  
AftershowingPleaseWait!”, theLCDreturnstotheNor-  
mal screen.  
8
See page 56 “Recorder functions.”  
<Unarming tracks>  
To unarm tracks now recorded, press the flashing  
[TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys again. The keys  
changes to light in green.  
Nowyouhaverecordedastereosourceontotwotracks  
(3 and 4).  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Mark function  
The VF80 has the Mark function which allows you to set marks at the desired positions in a song.  
Youcanlocateamarkpositionimmediately, aswellasusemarkpositionsforthepunchinand outpoints, beginning  
and end points for repeat and editing points for track editing such as copy, move, erase, etc.  
This section describes how to set, delete and locate a mark. For details about editing a mark, see “Recorder func-  
tions” described later.  
Setting a mark on the fly  
Locating a mark  
In the initial condition, Mark 00 is automatically en-  
tered at the beginning of the current program (ABS  
0) and named “ABS 0”.  
You can locate a mark using the [| ] or [ |] key.  
Current position  
You can enter up to 99 marks (Mark 01 through 99).  
Mark number and name are shown on the Normal  
screen as the arrow points in the screen example be-  
low. (You cannot edit or delete Mark 00.)  
[
I] key  
[I  
] key  
• Pressing [| ] key locates the previous mark.  
In the example above, each time you press the key from  
the current position, the recorder will locate Mark 03 ->  
02 -> 01 -> 00.  
• Pressing [ |] key locates the next mark.  
In the example above, each time you press the key from  
the current position, the recorder will locate Mark 04 ->  
05 -> 06.  
Duringplayback(orwhilestopped),press[| /MARK]  
1
key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
Entry Mark” is shown briefly and a mark is entered at  
the current position.  
Also the time marked is entered in the mark map list  
(see “Recorder functions” for details).  
The current (located) mark number is shown on the  
Normal screen.  
To enter another mark, repeat step 1) above.  
2
<Note>  
Marks are assigned in ascending order of ABS time.  
For example, even if you enter marks in order as shown  
in the upper diagram below, the mark numbers are as-  
signed as shown in the lower diagram.  
Deleting a mark  
You can delete unnecessary mark  
While stopped, locate the mark to be deleted using the  
1
[| ] or [ |] key.  
The mark to be deleted is shown on the screen.  
Press the [ |/DELETE] key while holding down the  
2
[SHIFT] key.  
A pop-up panel asking for confirmation to delete the  
current mark appears, in which “Sure?” blinks.  
To cancel the operation for deletion, press the [EXIT/  
NO] key.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while holding down the  
3
[RECORD] key.  
The current mark is deleted.  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
ABS locate functions  
There are four types of the ABS locate functions as below.  
• Pressing the [REWIND] key while holding down the [STOP] key locates the beginning of the current program  
(ABS 00), regardless of the time base setting.  
• Pressing the [F FWD] key while holding down the [STOP] key locates the end position of the last recording of the  
current program (REC END).  
You can use this function to locate the end point of a song or to check the length of a song.  
• Pressing the [PLAY] key while holding down the [STOP] key locates the beginning of the last playback.  
• Pressing the [RECORD] key while holding down the [STOP] key locates the beginning of the last recording.  
Punch in/out  
If you are not satisfied with your recording and want to modify only a specific part, you can replace the part with  
a new recording using the punch in/out technique.  
Punch in” switches the transport mode from playback to recording, while “Punch out” switches the transport  
mode from recording to playback. The point at which a punch in is carried out is called a “punch in point”, while  
the point at which a punch out is carried out is called a “punch out point.”  
You can carry out the punch in/out operation in 3 ways:  
Punch in/out using the foot switch  
* Manual punch in/out using the keys on the unit  
* Using the foot switch (Model 8051)  
* Auto punch in/out function  
After setting the punch in and out points, the punch  
in/out can be took place automatically.  
Connect the Model 8051 foot switch to the [FOOT SW]  
jack.  
1
FOOT SW (Model 8051)  
The following description is assumed that the track(s)  
to be punched in/out are armed and the source input  
level is set appropriately by using the [TRIM] knob.  
[FOOT SW] jack  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
PHONES  
ST OUT  
FW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
L
R
Manual punch in/out using the keys on the unit  
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
Start playback by pressing the [PLAY] key from a po-  
1
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
TRAINING  
BOUNCE  
REC EFF  
MASTERING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
sition before the punch in point.  
PEAK  
PEAK  
F1  
F2  
F3  
PHANTOM  
<Note>  
Whentheplaybackpositionreachesthepunchinpoint,  
2
Do not power on the machine with non-specified foot  
SW connected to the foot SW jack.  
pressthe[RECORD]keywhileholdingdownthe[PLAY]  
key.  
When powering on the machine with non-specified  
foot SW (latch type foot SW, etc.) connected to the  
foot SW jack, there is a case that the machine does  
not correctly boot up with “No Drive!” alert message.  
In such a case, power off the machine once, discon-  
nect the foot SW and then power back on.  
Onlythearmedtrack(s)switchfromplaybacktorecord-  
ing.  
At the punch out point, press the [PLAY] key .  
3
The armed track(s) switch from recording to playback.  
Start playback by pressing the [PLAY] key from a po-  
sition before the punch in point.  
2
3
Whentheplaybackpositionreachesthepunchinpoint,  
step on the foot switch.  
Onlythearmedtrack(s)switchfromplaybacktorecord-  
ing.  
At the punch out point, step on the foot switch.  
The armed track(s) switch from recording to playback.  
4
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
• Setting the punch in/out points numerically  
While the recorder is stopped, you can set the in and  
out points by entering the time numerically.  
Auto punch in/out function  
You must set the punch in and out points before per-  
forming auto punch in/out recording.  
You can set the points either during playback and  
whilestopped. Inthefollowingdescription,weassume  
that the “ABS” time base is selected.  
While stopped, press the [AUTO PUNCH/EDIT] key  
1
while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
The screen for setting the punch in/out points appears.  
• Setting the punch in/out points on the fly during playback  
(or while stopped)  
Pressthe[AUTOPUNCH/EDIT]keywhileholdingdown  
1
the [SHIFT] key.  
The screen for setting the punch in/out points appears.  
During playback, this counter shows the current  
recorder position in real time.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while the punch in point  
2
value is highlighted on the screen as above.  
Now you can edit the punch in point value.  
Initially, the “seconds” value starts blinking, showing  
that it can be edited.  
At the point at which you want to set the punch in point,  
2
press the [SETUP/F1] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
In Point Stored!” appears briefly, and the point is stored  
as the punch in point.  
Flashing  
Move the blinking value by using the [CURSOR / ]  
3
key and enter the desired value using the [JOG] dial.  
After completing editing the time value, press the [EN-  
4
TER/YES] key.  
The edited time is stored as the punch in point.  
Use the [CURSOR down] key to highlight the punch out  
5
point value, and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
Now you can edit the punch out point value.  
The time (or bar/beat) stored is shown here.  
Atthepointatwhichyouwanttosetthepunchoutpoint,  
3
press the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while holding down  
the [SHIFT] key.  
OutPointStored!appearsbriefly, andthepointatwhich  
you carry out the operation above is stored as the punch  
out point.  
Flashing  
Enter the desired value with the same method as en-  
6
tering the punch in point,then press the [ENTER/YES]  
key.  
The edited time is stored as the punch out point.  
The time (or bar/beat) stored is shown here.  
After storing times for both points,press the [EXIT/NO]  
7
key.  
<Note>  
The LCD returns to the Normal screen.  
Set the punch in point earlier than the punch out point.  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
• Performing auto punch in/out recording  
Taking a mark point in the punch in or punch out point  
After storing the punch in and out points, you can  
perform the auto punch in/out recording.  
You can take a mark point in the punch in or out point.  
<Note>  
Press the [AUTO PUNCH /EDIT] key (to illuminate the  
1
The following operation is possible only when any marks  
are stored using the Mark function described earlier.  
key).  
The auto punch mode is now active.  
Locate the earlier position to the punch in point.  
Press the [RECORD] key while holding down the  
2
3
Pressthe[AUTOPUNCH/EDIT]keywhileholdingdown  
1
the [SHIFT] key.  
The screen for setting the punch in/out points appears.  
[PLAY] key.  
A “take” of auto punch in/out recording starts and  
TAKE” lights up on the screen.  
The recorder starts playback, and then automatically  
puts into the record mode at the punch in point. It  
automatically switches to playback at the punch out  
point.  
<Rehearsal>  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL] key when the in point time  
2
In the step 3) above, if you press only the[PLAY] key,  
a “rehearsal” of auto punch in/out recording starts  
and “RHSL” lights up on the screen.  
In the rehearsal mode, when the recorder reaches  
the punch in point, only the monitor of the armed  
track(s)switchestoInputmonitorwithoutperform-  
ing actual recording.  
value is highlighted (as above).  
The highlighted line changes to show a mark.  
You can rehearse as many times as you like before  
actual recording.  
Hint:  
If you use the loop function together with the re-  
hearsal mode, you can rehearse your playing re-  
peatedly without the need of the recorder opera-  
tion, allowing you to concentrate on your playing.  
See “Recorder functions” for details about the loop  
function.  
Showing a mark.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
3
The highlighted mark starts blinking.  
Blinking  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired mark, and then  
4
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The selected mark position is taken in the punch  
in point.  
Use the [CURSOR ] key to highlight the punch out  
5
point value, and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired mark, and then  
6
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The selected mark position is taken in the punch out  
point.  
After setting both points, press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
7
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Mixing  
After recording all tracks (1 through 8), you can tailor the sound of each track. The following describes about  
settings for level, pan, EQ and effects.  
Set the pan position using the [JOG] dial.  
The pan icon on the screen changes in real time accord-  
Adjusting levels  
3
Adjust the playback level of each track using the cor-  
ing to the rotation of the [JOG] dial.  
1
2
responding fader (1 through 6 and 7/8).  
The levels of tracks 7 and 8 are simultaneously con-  
trolled by a single fader (7/8).  
Repeat steps 2) and 3) to set other tracks.  
4
5
After completing the pan setting, press the [EXIT/NO]  
key.  
The LCD returns to the Normal screen.  
Adjust the stereo master output (ST OUT L/R) levels  
using the [MASTER] fader.  
<About master output levels>  
Adjusting EQ  
You can view the stereo master output (L/R) levels  
from the L/R level meters on the screen. The output  
levels are affected by the [MASTER] fader position.  
Be sure not to set the fader level too high to avoid  
the sound distorted.  
Press the [EQ] key.  
The EQ screen is shown, where “SelectTRK!” is flashing  
in the initial condition.  
1
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
Setting pan position  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
You can set the pan position of each track.  
ON/OFF  
TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
REC EFF  
MANG  
TRAINING  
Press the [PAN] key.  
1
The pan setting screen is shown, where “SelectTRK!” is  
flashing in the initial condition.  
[EQ] key  
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
Flashing  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
[PAN] key  
ON/OFF  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
REC EFF  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
Press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key of the de-  
sired track.  
2
The default preset library entry (“L00: 2-SHLV”) is  
shown, in which the High Gain field is highlighted,  
showing that it can be edited.  
Flashing  
highlighted  
Press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key of the de-  
sired track (or use the [CURSOR / ] keys to select  
2
the desired track).  
The pan icon of the selected track is highlighted, show-  
ing that it is editable.  
<Selecting from the EQ library>:  
There are 36 presets besides the default preset in the  
EQ library. You can select a desired preset accord-  
ing to the situation and tailor the sound. See “Mixer  
functions” for details.  
highlighted  
Edit theHi Gainvalue using the [JOG] dial.  
The EQ curve is shown according to the value setting,  
while the sound changes in real time.  
3
You can set the value between -18 dB and + 18 dB.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Highlight theLo Gainfield by using the [CURSOR  
]
Use the [JOG] dial to enter the send level.  
While the send level changes, the corresponding icon  
also changes in real time.  
When the value increases, the effect sound of the cur-  
rently selected effect type will be output.  
4
3
4
key, and edit theLo Gainvalue using the [JOG] dial.  
You can set the value between -18 dB and + 18 dB, as  
same as the Hi Gain.  
Repeat steps 2 through 4 to edit EQ on other tracks.  
5
6
To set the effect send levels for other tracks, carry out  
step 2 and 3 above repeatedly.  
After completing the EQ setting, press the [EXIT/NO]  
key.  
The LCD returns to the Normal screen.  
Effect type setting  
Setting effects  
The VF80 provides 38 effect types (L01 through L38) used  
for the loop effect and 6 effect types (L39 through L44) used  
for the insert effect.  
There are two methods for using the internal effect  
processor of the VF80: “loop effect” and “insert effect”.  
The following describes how to set the send level and  
select an effect type of the loop effect.  
See “Mixer Function” for details about the loop effect,  
such as how to make pre/post setting of an effect send  
or how to set effect parameters.  
Bring up the effect type setting screen and select the  
2
desired effect type by rotating the [JOG] dial.  
While rotating the [JOG] dial, the effect type appears  
one after the other among 38 types (L01 ~ L38).  
See also “Advanced Operations” on page 83 for details  
about the insert effect.  
Highlighted  
Press the [EFFECT] key.  
1
The effect send level setting screen appears initially.  
Each press of the [EFFECT] key switches between the  
effect send level setting screen, effect type selection  
screen and effect send pre/post selection screen.  
<Note>  
If you select an effect type used for the insert effect  
(i.e. any one of L39 through L44), the screens for  
effect type selection and effect send pre/post selec-  
tion are not shown.  
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
[EFFECT] key  
ON/OFF  
After selecting the desired effect type, press the [EN-  
3
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
REC EFF  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
TER/YES] key.  
The selected effect type is set.  
Pressthe[EFFECT]keytobringuptheeffectsendlevel  
4
Flashing  
setting screen.  
Adjust the effect send levels as described above.  
5
<Pre/post setting of effect sends>  
All the effect sends from tracks 1 through 6 are  
initiallysettopost-fader”. Therefore, whenatrack  
fader is completely down, no signal is sent even if  
you raise the effect send level of the track.  
You can also select “pre-fader” if necessary.  
See “Mixer functions” for details.  
Effect send level setting  
While the effect send level setting screen is shown,  
press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key of the  
2
desired track.  
<Parameter setting for each effect type>  
You can set parameters for the selected effect type.  
See “Mixer functions” for details about parameter  
setting.  
The effect knob icon of the selected track is highlighted,  
showingthatitcanbeedited. Thedefaultvaluefortrack  
sends 1 through 6 is “0” while the default value for the  
master is “80”.  
<On/Off setting of the effect>  
highlighted  
You can switch on or off the effect alternately by  
pressing the [EFFECT/ON/OFF] key while holding  
down the [SHIFT] key.  
See “Mixer functions” for details.  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic Recording/Playback  
Mixdown  
After tailoring sound of all the tracks, let’s make a master tape (disc) using your master recorder (cassette, DAT,  
MD, etc.). As the VF80 can feed the stereo outputs (L and R) via the S/PDIF (coaxial) digital output jack, you can  
make the master tape (disc) in digital domain if your recorder provides a digital input jack. If your digital re-  
corder only provides the optical input jack, use the Fostex COP-1 optical to coaxial converter.  
Digital mixdown  
<Using the mastering mode/internal mastering mode:>  
The VF80 provides the “mastering mode” and “internal  
mastering mode”.  
In the mastering mode, you can record a material mixed  
down to track 7 and 8 to an external master recorder,  
while applying sound processing. The mastering mode  
allows you to perform advanced mastering.  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF  
OUTPUT  
/
DATA  
INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
INPUT  
See “Advanced Operations” on page 76 for details about the  
mastering mode.  
Intheinternalmasteringmode, youcancreateamastersong  
inside the VF80, without the need of using an external  
master recorder. Also, you can create an audio CD from  
master materials mastered in the mastering mode. (Note  
thatyouneedtheoptionalCD-RWdrivetocreateanaudio  
CD.)  
See “Advanced Operations” on page 79 for details about the  
internal mastering mode, and “Save/load of song data” on  
page 115 for details about creating an audio CD.  
Digital master recorder  
Connect the [DATA OUTPUT] jack to the digital input  
jack of your master recorder.  
Analog mixdown  
1
2
Analog master recorder  
Set the master recorder’s recording source to the digi-  
tal input.  
• The sampling frequency of the VF80 is fixed to 44.1  
kHz, so you cannot record the VF80 digital output  
signal to the master recorder that cannot accept 44.1  
kHz digital signals.  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
PHONES  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
• In general, you cannot adjust the digital input level  
of a digital recorder.  
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
Adjust the stereo output level of the VF80 using the  
[MASTER] fader.  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
3
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
TRAINING  
BOUNCE  
REC EFF  
MASTERING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
• In general, set the fader so that the level meter on the  
master recorder indicates “0” when the VF80 feeds  
the loudest level signal.  
Connect the [ST OUT - L/R] jacks to the input jacks of  
your analog master recorder.  
1
If the level is too high, the sound may be distorted.  
Startrecordingthemasterrecorder,andstartplayback  
of theVF80 from the beginning of the song.  
4
5
Set the recording level of the master recorder.  
2
3
When recording finishes, stop both the units.  
Startrecordingthemasterrecorder,andstartplayback  
of theVF80 from the beginning of the song.  
When recording finishes, stop both the units.  
4
<Fade in/out:>  
You can fade in or fade out a song by using the [MASTER]  
fader.  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Mixer Functions  
Initial condition when turning on the power  
When turning on the power, the VF80 starts up while showing the unit information on the LCD display and then  
gets ready when the screen below appears. This screen is called "Normal Screen", in which the program number  
and current recorder position are shown. In the following example (the default), Program 1 (P01) is loaded and  
the current position is the beginning (ABS 00M 00S).  
Normal screen  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PHONES  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
Lighting in green  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
Lighting in orange  
Operations while the Normal screen is shown  
Fader  
The [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key for the muted  
track is unlit. Pressing the key again releases muting  
and lights up the key.  
The fader for each track (1 through 6 and 7/8) con-  
trols the level of the playback signal fed to the stereo  
outputs.  
Master fader mute  
Track mute  
While the VF80 is not in the mix parameter edit mode,  
pressing the [STATUS/SEL] key for the master fader  
mutes the stereo outputs.  
While the stereo outputs are muted, the [STATUS/SEL]  
key is unlit. Pressing the key again releases muting  
and lights up the key.  
While the VF80 is not in the mix parameter edit mode,  
pressing any one of the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL]  
keys (for tracks 1 through 6 and 7/8) mutes the cor-  
responding track.  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Mix parameter section  
The Mix parameter section provides five keys that are used for mixer function settings.  
By pressing one of these keys alone or while holding down the [SHIFT] key, you can execute the following.  
<Note>  
The VF80 mixer channels always receive corresponding track signals. They do not receive input signals.  
•Pan setting  
MIX PARAMETER  
•EQ setting  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
•Effect send level setting  
•Effect send pre/post setting  
•Effect type/parameter setting  
•Effect on/off setting  
•Save/load/delete of a scene memory  
•Scene sequence mode on/off setting  
•Mark map setting  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
PAN  
EFFECT  
•Fader view  
ON/OFF  
Adjusting pan positions  
You can adjust the pan position of each track signal fed to the stereo outputs.  
Use the [JOG] dial to adjust the pan position.  
The pan position is set according to the rotating degree.  
The following show examples of the pan settings.  
Press the [PAN] key.  
The pan screen appears.  
3
1
If you have not edited any track parameter for pan, EQ  
or effect send setting after turning on the power last  
time, the message prompting to select a track ("Select  
TRK!") flashes, as well as all the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK  
SEL] keys on the panel flash.  
If you have edited any track parameter for pan, EQ or  
effect send setting after turning on the power last time,  
the icon for the previously edited track is highlighted,  
showing that it can be edited.  
Pan position:  
Pan position:  
hard right  
Pan position:  
hard left  
center  
•Controllable tracks  
Tracks 1 through 6 and 7/8  
Flashing  
•Available values  
L10 (hard left) through C (center) to R10 (hard right)  
(the default setting: "C" for all tracks)  
To adjust the pan position for another track, repeat  
steps 2 and 3 above.  
4
5
Select the desired track by pressing the correspond-  
ing [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key (or using the  
After completing pan setting, press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The VF80 exits the mix parameter edit mode and the  
LCD display returns to the Normal screen.  
2
[CURSOR / ] keys).  
The pan icon of the selected track is highlighted, indi-  
cating that you can edit it.  
The[TRACKSTATUS/TRACKSEL] keyoftheselectedtrack  
flashes.  
Highlighted  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Editing EQ  
The VF80 is equipped with 2-band (HI and LO) EQ for Tracks 1 through 6.  
36 preset entries are available in the EQ library.  
<Note>  
Selectable from 36 preset library entries (L00  
through L36).The default is "L00: 2-SHLV.  
After selecting the desired library, press the [EN-  
TER/YES] key to confirm the setting.  
You can apply EQ only to Tracks 1 through 6. You cannot  
apply EQ to Tracks 7/8.  
Library  
Press the [EQ] key.  
1
*See the following table for details about the EQ  
library.  
The EQ screen appears.  
If you have not edited any track parameter for EQ, pan  
or effect send setting after turning on the power last  
time, the message prompting to select a track ("Select  
TRK!") flashes, as well as the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK  
SEL] keys for Tracks 1 through 6 on the panel flash.  
If you have edited any track parameter for pan, EQ or  
effect send setting after turning on the power last time,  
the icon for the previously edited track is highlighted,  
showing that it can be edited.  
Setting example 1: Set "Hi Gain" to "+11 dB."  
Thehighfrequencygainisboostedupasshowngraphi-  
cally.  
Flashing  
Setting example 2: Set "Lo Gain" to "-8 dB."  
The low frequency gain is cut as shown graphically.  
Select the desired track by pressing the correspond-  
2
ing [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key (or using the  
[CURSOR / ] keys).  
The selected track number and library entry name  
(shown as "EQ-1" and "L00:2-SHLV" respectively in the  
screen example below) are shown, together with the  
current settings. The gain value of Hi EQ ("Hi Gain")  
flashes, indicating that you can edit it.  
Setting example 3: Set "EQ library" to "L03."  
Thehighfrequencygainisboostedupasshowngraphi-  
cally.  
Flashing  
By using the [JOG] dial to select "L03": Ana.Kick" and  
pressing the [ENTER/YES] key, the preset parameter  
values are shown together with the corresponding EQ  
curve.  
Use the [CURSOR  
be edited.  
Each time you press the [CURSOR ] key, the flashing  
parameter (to be edited) changes in the following or-  
der. Hi Gain -> Lo Gain -> EQ ON/OFF -> library entry  
->Hi Gain...  
/
] key to select a parameter to  
You can edit parameters from this preset condition and  
store the setting as a scene. Note that if you turn off  
the power, the setting is cleared.  
3
4
Pressing the [CURSOR ] key changes the flashing pa-  
rameter in the reverse order.  
Use the [JOG] dial to edit the parameter value.  
The following values are available for each parameter.  
-18 dB through 0 dB to +18 dB in 1 dB steps.  
Hi Gain  
The current EQ curve is shown graphically accord-  
ing to the current values.  
To edit the EQ for another track,repeat steps 2 through  
4.  
5
6
-18 dB through 0 dB to +18 dB in 1 dB steps.  
The current EQ curve is shown graphically accord-  
ing to the current values.  
Lo Gain  
ON/OFF  
After completing EQ editing, press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The VF80 exits the EQ edit mode and the LCD display  
returns to the Normal screen.  
ON or OFF of EQ  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Preset entries in the EQ library  
LO  
HI  
LO  
HI  
-18.0  
L00: 2-SHLV  
L10: Lo-Fi_Cym  
0
0
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
+3.0  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Removes the brightness from a  
cymbal sound by cutting high fre-  
quencies.  
Flat setting  
The first time you bring up the EQ  
screen, this entry is selected.  
4kHz  
H-S  
8kHz  
H-S  
400Hz  
L-S  
300Hz  
1.6  
LO  
HI  
L11: Perc.  
LO  
HI  
L01: LightKick  
-4.0  
+7.0  
6kHz  
H-S  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
+6.0  
400Hz  
L-S  
-12.0  
600Hz  
5.0  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Creates a bright sound by empha-  
sizing the attack of a conga, bongo,  
etc.  
Creates a light and jaunty kick  
sound  
100Hz  
L-S  
LO  
HI  
L12:Tamb.  
LO  
HI  
L02:TightKick  
-8.0  
+10.0  
5.4kHz  
H-S  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
+7.0  
400Hz  
L-S  
+10.0  
4kHz  
8.0  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Creates a subtle sound by empha-  
sizingthepresenceofatambourine,  
etc.  
Creates a tight and hard kick sound.  
360Hz  
L-S  
LO  
HI  
L13: Fat_Bass  
LO  
HI  
L03: Ana.Kick  
+5.0  
100Hz  
0.1  
+3.0  
2.4kHz  
6.3  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
+5.0  
550Hz  
L-S  
-9.0  
6kHz  
H-S  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Creates a fat base sound by slightly  
boosting the low frequency range.  
Makesananalogkicksoundboomy.  
LO  
HI  
L14: Norm.Bass  
LO  
HI  
L04: Snappy_SD  
+5.0  
190Hz  
1.0  
+4.0  
2.4kHz  
1.0  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
-7.0  
1kHz  
L-S  
+6.0  
3.5kHz  
2.5  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Creates a all-round bass sound.  
Makes a snare sound snappier.  
LO  
HI  
L15: Loud_Bass  
LO  
HI  
L05: Power_SD  
+4.0  
120Hz  
2.0  
+3.0  
1.3kHz  
2.2  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
+8.0  
150Hz  
4.5  
+5.0  
3.5kHz  
2.5  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Creates a good analog bass sound  
byboostingthelowfrequencyrange  
and emphasizing the attack.  
Createsapowerfulandheavysnare  
sound.  
LO  
HI  
LO  
HI  
L16: Bright_Pf  
L06: Deep_SD  
+4.0  
5kHz  
H-S  
Gain -3.0  
+3.0  
550Hz  
4.5  
+4.0  
4.3kHz  
2.2  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Creates a bright piano sound.  
Creates a heavy sound of a snare  
drum with a deep body.  
Freq.  
Q
340Hz  
0.9  
LO  
HI  
L17: Loud_Pf  
LO  
HI  
L07:Talk_Tom  
+5.0  
-3.0  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
+7.0  
3.2kHz  
6.3  
Gain +4.0  
Creates a rich piano sound by  
boosting the low frequency range  
which contains rich harmonics.  
Creates a skinny tom-tom sound.  
1.3kHz  
0.9  
200Hz  
L-S  
Freq.  
Q
100Hz  
7.1  
LO  
HI  
L08: Melo.Tom  
LO  
HI  
L18: Power_Pf  
+6.0  
-12.0  
1.7kHz  
2.2  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
-13.0  
170Hz  
0.7  
+7.0  
5.4kHz  
1.1  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Creates a melodious sound.  
Creates a tight and smooth sound.  
Suitable for a piano solo.  
100Hz  
2.8  
LO  
HI  
LO  
HI  
L09:W.GongTom  
L19: E.Pf  
-10.0  
130Hz  
L-S  
+17.0  
520Hz  
7.1  
+3.0  
6.4kHz  
1.7  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Gain +8.0  
Createsasoundwhichemphasizes  
the attack and distortion when hit-  
ting keyboards of an electric piano.  
Makes a tom-tom sound woody.  
Freq.  
Q
1kHz  
0.7  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
LO  
HI  
+3.0  
L30: Male_Vo  
LO  
HI  
+4.0  
L20: Clean_EG  
Gain +2.0  
Gain -4.0  
Adds a bright character to a trans-  
parent and clean electric guitar  
sound.  
Effective for a male vocal  
6.2kHz  
H-S  
Freq.  
Q
2kHz  
0.5  
6.6kHz  
H-S  
Freq.  
Q
100Hz  
L-S  
LO  
HI  
L31: Female_Vo  
LO  
HI  
L21: CrunCh_EG  
+4.0  
Gain -5.0  
-2.0  
+6.0  
4kHz  
1.4  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Makes a moderately distorted  
crunchelectricguitarsound distinc-  
tive.  
Effective for a female vocal  
5.8kHz  
H-S  
Freq.  
Q
170Hz  
120Hz  
0.7  
0.7  
LO  
HI  
L32: Chorus  
LO  
HI  
L22: OverDrvEG  
-5.0  
+5.0  
10kHz  
H-S  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Effective for a whole chorus part by  
emphasizing the high frequency  
range.  
+6.0  
310Hz  
1.5  
+7.0  
1.3kHz  
1.1  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Makes a mellow overdriven electric  
guitar sound fatter.  
120Hz  
0.7  
LO  
HI  
L33: SpeeCh  
LO  
HI  
L23: Dist.EG  
+3.0  
10kHz  
H-S  
Gain ON  
Makes a narration clear.  
+4.0  
3.6kHz  
10  
Gain +6.0  
Makes a hardly distorted electric  
guitar sound distinctive.  
Freq.  
Q
180Hz  
HPF  
Freq.  
Q
370Hz  
L-S  
LO  
HI  
L34: Digi.Mix  
LO  
HI  
L24: Metal_EG  
+6.0  
12kHz  
H-S  
Gain +5.0  
Makes an analog open-reel or cas-  
sette tape sound closer to a digital Freq.  
sound.  
+12.0  
14kHz  
H-S  
Gain +3.0  
Makes a high-gain metal sound dis-  
tinctive.  
100Hz  
L-S  
Freq.  
Q
230Hz  
0.7  
Q
LO  
HI  
L35: AnalogMix  
LO  
HI  
L25: Stroke_AG  
ON  
Gain ON  
Cuts the high frequency range and  
provides an opposite character to  
L34.  
+8.0  
9kHz  
1.2  
Gain -9.0  
Suppresses a hole resonance of an  
acoustic guitar and makes a code  
stroke sound powerful.  
8kHz  
LPF  
Freq.  
Q
250Hz  
Freq.  
Q
100Hz  
0.7  
HPF  
LO  
HI  
L36:Telephone  
LO  
HI  
L26: Arpeg.EAG  
ON  
ON  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
+3.0  
9.4kHz  
0.1  
Gain -2.0  
Emphasizes the mid range only to  
provideatelephonereceiversound.  
Controlsthearpeggiocodebalance  
of an electro-acoustic guitar.  
5.6kHz  
LPF  
1.2kHz  
HPF  
Freq.  
Q
210Hz  
L-S  
LO  
HI  
L27: Arpeg.AG  
Tips:  
+5.0  
Gain -7.0  
“L-S(Low shelving type)  
This equalizer affects all frequencies below a specified  
frequency when applying boost or cut.  
Suppresses a hole resonance of an  
acoustic guitar and makes an ar-  
peggio brighter.  
4.4kHz  
H-S  
Freq.  
Q
530Hz  
7.1  
“H-S” (High shelving type)  
This equalizer affects all frequencies below a specified  
frequency when applying boost or cut.  
LO  
HI  
L28: Brass_Sec  
-3.0  
+4.0  
5.6kHz  
5.0  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
Controlsthebalanceofbrassinstru-  
ments (such as trumpets, trom-  
bones. etc.).  
100Hz  
2.5  
“LPF(Low pass filter)  
This filter passes frequencies below a cut-off frequency  
while cuts frequencies above the frequency.  
LO  
HI  
L29:W.WindSec  
“HPF” (High pass filter)  
This filter passes frequencies below a cut-off frequency  
while cuts frequencies above the frequency.  
+4.0  
260Hz  
2.2  
Gain +3.0  
Makes the mid frequency range of  
woodwind instruments (such as  
clarinets, oboe, etc.) richer.  
Freq.  
Q
125Hz  
L-S  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Setting Effects  
The VF80 provides 38 digital effect types used for the loop effect and 6 types used for the insert effect.  
As you can select any type and adjust parameter settings for each type, comprehensive effect pro-  
cessing is possible.  
Employing the Fostex A.S.P. (Fostex Advanced Signal Processing Technology*), the internal DSP multi-  
effect processor realizes superb ambience effects. In addition, the newly developed "A.S.P. +" achieves  
simulations of microphones/amplifiers with overwhelming reality.  
<About "Loop effect" and "Insert effect">  
Using a loop effect you can process sound recorded on tracks during track bouncing (ping-pong) or mixdown.  
The processed sound is recorded to the other track(s) of the unit or external master recorder.  
Using an insert effect, you can process sound on any of tracks 1 through 6 using a distortion or simulation  
effect, and rerecord the processed sound to the same track.  
* A. S. P. (Fostex Advanced Signal ProcessingTechnology)  
The A. S. P. is an exclusive new digital effect processing technology designed by Fostex.  
This method extracts maximum efficiency from the limited DSP power.  
It achieves an overwhelmingly high density Early Reflection sound and wonderfully smooth  
High Dump response through the H. F. A. (Harmonic Feedback Algorithm). Also, it car-  
ries out an elaborate reverb simulation with clear sounds through the H. D. L. P. (Hi-  
Density Logarithmic Processing), which eliminates the mutual interference between the  
numerous integrated delay modules and reduce the impurity and girt of the sound.  
* H. F. A. (Harmonic Feedback Algorithm)  
There is one of indispensable elements in the natural echo called “Early Reflection Sound,” which is usually  
sacrificed in commercial reverb products in order to reduce costs. (In practice, the Early Reflection Sound  
means the very first reverberated sound that bounces back from walls, floors and ceilings of concert halls).  
The entire reverb sound quality depends on this Early Reflection Sound and how closely it can resemble the  
real echo. The H. F. A. is an algorithm that enables the effect unit to reproduce a clear and natural Early  
Reflection Sound by applying an ideal harmonic feedback to each delay module.  
* H. D. L. P. (Hi-Density Logarithmic Processing)  
The reverb sounds consist of lots of small delay elements combined in a complex way, which are produced  
by many delay modules inside the effect unit. In order to obtain smooth and comfortable reverb sounds,  
it is very important to efficiently organize the relationship between each delay module and minimize  
negative mutual interference. The H. D. L. P. is a technology which applies efficient logarithmic processing  
to each delay module, so that they can work in the most efficient way in order to eliminate harmful reverb  
elements and roughness. This makes it possible to establish high density and transparent sounds.  
About "A.S.P.+"  
Combining the ambience effect technology established through the development of "A.P.S."with acoustic  
theories accumulated through the development of transducers such as monitor speakers for many years,  
Fostex developed a unique simulation algorithm engine called "A.S.P.+", which performs overwhelmingly  
realistic microphone/amplifier simulation.  
To simulate a microphone, the frequency response of the microphone, which is the most essential factor  
that decides the sound character of each famous/popular microphone, must be reproduced correctly. To  
get this, "A.P.S.+" carries out a double accuracy operation for each frequency range using the unique "D.A.O."  
(Double Accuracy Operation).  
Regarding a guitar amplifier, the peak and dip of the specific frequencies, as well as feedback of the peak  
frequency'sharmonics, arethemostessentialfactorsthatdecidethesoundcharacterofeachfamous/popular  
amplifier. To simulate such a unique character, "A.P.S.+" carries out a double accuracy operation for each  
frequency range using the "D.A.O." (Double Accuracy Operation) to simulate the frequency curve, as well  
as carries out harmonics feedback processing using the "H.F.A." (Harmonics Feedback Algorithm).  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Before describing detail for the VF80 effect setting, we briefly explain each effect type (reverb, delay,  
chorus, flanger, distortion and simulator).  
Reverb:  
Chorus:  
The so called Reverb effect consists of various reflection  
sounds mixed together. For example, when you clap your  
hands in a tunnel, you will hear the sound linger even  
after you stop clapping your hands. This is the Reverb.  
The sounds we normally hear in daily life have three types  
of sounds mixed together, i.e., “Direct sound,” “Early Re-  
flection sound” and “Late Reflection sound.”  
The Direct sound means the sound directly reaches the  
ears from the sound source. The Early Reflection sound  
means the sound that comes after the Direct sound and  
has rebound off the wall of the tunnel up to a few times.  
The Late Reflection sound means that the sound rebounds  
many times long after the Direct sound has disappeared.  
Our ears normally hear the “Direct sound” - “Early Reflec-  
tion sound” - “Late Reflection sound” in the order.  
This makes the one original sound appear to have many  
sources. The Chorus is used to widen or thicken the origi-  
nal sound.  
Flanger:  
The Flanger is one of applications of the Delay.  
This is used to create a sound like a jet airplane ascending  
or descending.  
Distortion:  
The distortion effect distorts the sound and adds harmon-  
ics. Fourtypesofthedistortioneffectareprovided:theguitar  
distortion, bass distortion, drum distortion and voice dis-  
tortion. The distortion is used for the insert effect.  
Simulation:  
Delay:  
Simulators for famous guitar amplifiers and microphones  
are provided. You can get a familiar distortion sound of a  
famous guitar amplifier or a popular microphone sound. A  
simulator can be used for the insert effect.  
This is the effect to added a delayed sound to the original  
sound. You can obtain a richer sound or completely change  
the original source sound by using the Delay.  
How to make the loop effect setting  
There are two methods for using the internal effect processor of the VF80; "loop effect" and "insert  
effect".  
The loop effect allows you to apply a desired effect to track signals during track bounce (ping-pong)  
operation to the other tracks or mixdown operation to an external master recorder.  
The insert effect is applied when rerecording any of recorded tracks 1 through 6.  
The following describes how to make settings for the loop effect. See "Advanced Operations" on page  
83 for details about the insert effect.  
<Note>  
The effect settings described here are only available to Tracks 1 through 6.  
On Track 7/8, the dedicated "Mastering processing" is built in and you can apply the reverb, compressor, etc. while trans-  
ferring audio on the master tracks (7/8) to an external recorder. See "Advanced Operations" for details.  
Track 1  
Track 2  
Track 3  
Track 4  
Track 5  
Track 6  
Track 7  
Track 8  
Track 1  
Track 2  
Track 3  
Track 4  
Track 5  
Track 6  
Track 7  
Track 8  
ASP  
Effect  
ASP  
Effect  
Master Recorder  
Mixing down tracks 1 through 6 and recording to an external  
master recorder.  
Bouncing tracks 1 through 6 to tracks 7 and  
8.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Setting effect send levels  
<Hint>  
Wheneditingtheloopeffectsetting, pressingthe  
[EFFECT] key after turning on the power cycles  
the screen between "Effect send level setting  
screen", "Effect type/parameter setting screen" and  
"Effect send pre/post setting screen", as shown  
right.  
You can set send levels from Tracks 1 through 6 to the  
internal A.S.P. effect processor.  
Press the [EFFECT] key to bring up the send level  
1
setting screen.  
If you have not edited any track parameter for effect  
send, EQ or pan setting after turning on the power last  
time, the message prompting to select a track ("Select  
TRK!") flashes, as well as the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL]  
keys for Tracks 1 through 6 on the panel flash.  
If you have edited any track parameter for effect send,  
EQ or pan setting after turning on the power last time,  
the icon for the previously edited track is highlighted,  
showing that it can be edited.  
<Note>  
If you select one of effect types L39 through  
L44, the "Effect type/parameter setting  
screen" is shown and pressing the [EFFECT]  
key does not change the screen.  
This is because effect types L39 through L44  
areonlyusedasinserteffectsanddonothave  
the "Effect send level setting screen" and  
"Effect send pre/post setting screen"  
See "Advanced Operations" on page 83 for  
details about the insert effect.  
Flashing  
Select the desired track by pressing the correspond-  
2
ing [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key (or using the  
Effect send level setting screen  
[CURSOR / ] keys).  
The icon of the selected track is highlighted, indicat-  
ing that you can edit it.  
In the default settings, the send levels for Tracks 1  
through 6 are "00" while the level for Master is "80."  
Effect type/parameter setting screen  
Use the [JOG] dial to adjust the send level value.  
3
The knob icon also rotates according to the level value.  
Whenthelevelissetto"00", nosignalissenttotheeffect  
processor.  
Effect send pre/post setting screen  
• Editable tracks:  
• Level range:  
• Default level:  
Tracks 1 through 6  
00 through 99 in 1 step  
Tracks 1 through 6: 00, Master: 80  
To edit the send level for another track, repeat steps 2  
and 3 above.  
4
5
To edit the effect send master level, press the [STA-  
TUS/SEL] key of the master to highlight the master  
level icon,and then use the [JOG] dial to edit the value.  
The default level value is "80."  
After completing send level settings, press the [EXIT/  
NO] key.  
6
The LCD display returns to the Normal screen.  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Selecting an effect type  
Selecting Pre/Post of the effect send  
You can select the send signals from Tracks 1 through  
6 pre- or post- fader.  
When selecting Post, a signal after the track fader is  
sent to the effect processor. So if you set the fader  
completely down, no signal is sent to the effect pro-  
cessor.  
When selecting Pre, a signal before the track fader is  
sent to the effect processor. So even if you set the fader  
completely down, the signal is sent to the effect pro-  
cessor.  
<Note>  
Changing the effect preset may mute the sound mo-  
mentarily!  
Effect presets of the internal effect processor shown  
above are classified into three types; ambience/de-  
lay type (No. 1 through 28), modulation/pitch type  
(No. 29 through 36), pitch type (No. 37 and 38) and  
distortion/simulation type (No. 39 through 44).  
If you switch the effect preset between the three types  
above, the audio is momentarily muted.  
Press the [EFFECT] key to bring up the pre/post set-  
1
Press the [EFFECT] key to bring up the effect type/  
1
ting screen.  
parameter setting screen.  
If you have not edited any track parameter for effect  
send, EQ or pan setting after turning on the power last  
time, the message prompting to select a track ("Select  
TRK!") flashes,as well as the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL]  
keys for Tracks 1 through 6 on the panel flash.  
If you have edited any track parameter for effect send,  
EQ or pan setting after turning on the power last time,  
the switch icon for the previously edited track is high-  
lighted, showing that it can be edited.  
Thefirsttimeyoubringupthescreen, "L01:NormHALL"  
is selected as the effect type.  
From the second time on when bringing up the screen,  
the previously selected effect type is selected.  
Flashing  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired effect type.  
2
For the loop effect, you can select among L01 through  
L38.  
Effect types L39 through L44 are used for the insert  
effect (described later).  
When you select a type other than the current type, the  
type flashes.  
Select the desired track by pressing the correspond-  
2
ing [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key (or using the  
[CURSOR / ] keys).  
The switch icon of the selected track is highlighted,  
indicating that you can edit it.  
In the default settings, all Tracks 1 through 6 are set to  
"Post."  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key after selecting the effect  
3
type.  
Now you can edit the first parameter.  
Intheexamplebelow, the"EffLevel"valueishighlighted  
showing that it can be edited.  
Edit point  
Use the [JOG] dial to select "Pre" or "Post."  
3
The icon changes according to the selection as below.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select a value for the highlighted  
4
parameter.  
See "Effect parameter details" about the available pa-  
rameter values.  
Pre fader signal is sent to the effect processor.  
To set a value for another parameter,use the [CURSOR  
5
Post fader signal is sent to the effect processor.  
] key to select a parameter to be edited,and then use  
the [JOG] dial to select a value.  
• Selectable tracks:Tracks 1 through 6  
• Setting values: PRE or POST (the default is POST).  
After completing the settings,press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
6
The VF80 exits the edit mode and the LCD display re-  
turns to the Normal screen.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Turning the effect processor on or off  
You can select the on or off of the effect processor.  
To turn on the effect processor  
Press the [EFFECT/ON/OFF] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key to illuminate the [EFFECT/ON/OFF] key.  
The effect processor is turned on and you can hear "wet"  
sound.  
To turn off the effect processor  
Press the [EFFECT/ON/OFF] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key to illuminate the [EFFECT/ON/OFF] key.  
The effect processor is turned off and you can hear "dry"  
sound.  
You can also see the on/off status of the effect proces-  
sor in the effect type/parameter setting screen.  
This icon shows the on/off status of the effect processor.  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
About the effect types  
Effect types L01 through L38 are used for the loop effect, while L39 through L44 are used for the insert effect.  
Name  
Parameter type  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
Explanation  
L01 Norm HALL  
L02 Pres HALL  
L03 Wet HALL  
L04 NoER HALL  
L05 Lo-F HALL  
L06 STADIUM  
Standard hall reverb; detailed and transparent, with a moderate amount of early reflections.  
Hall reverb with presence and definition.  
Hall reverb with restrained high-frequency and a refreshing atmosphere.  
All-purpose hall reverb with no early reflections, and even decay of all frequencies.  
Hall reverb with lingering low-frequency reverberation.  
Stadium reverb characterized by long early reflections.  
L07 AUDITRIUM  
L08 HALLWAY  
L09 Norm ROOM  
L10 Dead ROOM  
L11 Pres ROOM  
L12 DrumBOOTH  
L13 GARAGE  
Reverb simulating an auditorium with suppressed reverberation.  
Reverb with a long pre-delay, creating the impression of an extended space.  
Room reverb simulating a moderate space with some sparkle.  
Room reverb simulating a narrow and dead room. Adding a slight amount will give warmth to the sound.  
All-purpose room reverb, with good definition and few early reflections.  
Room reverb simulating a drum booth.  
Room reverb simulating a narrow and live space like a garage, with crisp presence.  
Modern-sounding plate reverb with wide bandwidth.  
L14 NormPLATE  
L15 Old PLATE  
L16 PresPLATE  
L17 Wet PLATE  
L18 DigiPLATE  
L19 NormVOCAL  
L20 PresVOCAL  
Standard plate reverb with the character of older plate units.  
Plate reverb with good definition and extended high-frequencies.  
Plate reverb with a gentle character.  
Plate reverb that emphasizes a digital character, with metallic early reflections.  
All-purpose hall reverb with no early reflections, and uniform decay at all frequencies.  
Short reverberation with extended high frequency is added to the early reflections of an ideal vocal booth. Since  
this adds sparkle to the sound, it is effective when you wish to bring the vocal to the forefront.  
L21 SoloVOCAL  
L22 ArenaVOC  
L23 Arena CHO  
REVERB  
REVERB  
REVERB  
Plate-like reverb is added to a spacious short delay. This blends well with any genre of music.  
Gentle reverb is added to spacious stadium-type early reflections.  
Short reverb with extended high frequency is added to spacious stadium-type early reflections. Effective on  
chorus parts.  
L24 KARAOKE  
L25 MnDL-HALL  
L26 MnDL-PLT  
L27 PnDL-HALL  
L28 PnDL-PLT  
L29 MonoDELAY  
L30 PanDELAY  
L31 MonoBpmDL  
L32 PanBpmDL  
L33 Short DL  
REVERB  
All-purpose reverb (karaoke style) that makes any vocal sound professional.  
A combined effect of mono delay and hall reverb.  
DLY+REVERB  
DLY+REVERB  
DLY+REVERB  
DLY+REVERB  
DELAY  
A combined effect of mono delay and plate reverb.  
A combined effect of panning delay and hall reverb.  
A combined effect of panning delay and plate reverb.  
Mono delay  
DELAY  
Panning delay  
BPM DELAY  
BPM DELAY  
SHORT DELAY  
DOUBLING  
CHORUS  
Mono delay. Specify BPM and note value to set the delay time.  
Panning delay. Specify BPM and note value to set the delay time.  
Short delay that allows you to set the delay time precisely.  
Doubling that allows you to set separate delay times for L and R.  
Produces a chorus effect. A doubling effect can also be added.  
Produces a flanging effect.  
L34 DOUBLING  
L35 CHORUS  
L36 FLANGE  
FLANGE  
L37 MonoPITCH  
L38 DlyPITCH  
L39 Dist Gtr  
MONO PITCH  
DELAY PITCH  
DISTORTION  
DISTORTION  
DISTORTION  
DISTORTION  
SIMULATION  
SIMULATION  
Pitch shift adjustable in a +/-2 octave range.  
Pitch shift with a feedback delay, allowing strange effects to be produced.  
Distortion sound for a guitar. (See "Advanced Operations" on page 83.)  
Distortion sound for a bass. (See "Advanced Operations" on page 83.)  
Distortion sound for drums. (See "Advanced Operations" on page 83.)  
Distortion sound for a voice. (See "Advanced Operations" on page 83.)  
You can simulates popular guitar amplifier sounds. (See "Advanced Operations" on page 83.)  
You can simulates famous microphone sounds. (See "Advanced Operations" on page 83.)  
L40 Dist Bass  
L41 Dist Drum  
L42 DistVoice  
L43 Gtr Amp Sim  
L44 Mic Sim  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Effect parameter details  
The parameters that can be adjusted will depend on the parameter type.  
The following describes parameters for effect types L01 through L38 used for the loop effect.  
See "Advanced Operations" on page 83 for details about parameters for effect types L39 through L44 used for  
the insert effect.  
Reverb effect parameters (parameter type: REVERB)  
For effect types 1--24 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following five parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Rev Time  
3. Pre Delay  
4. Hi Ratio  
5. E/R Level  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the length of reverberation. Range: 0.1--9.9 seconds  
Adjust the time from the original sound until reverberation begins. Range: 0--100 ms  
Adjust the decay ratio of the high frequencies. Range: 0--10  
Adjust the volume of the early reflections. Range: 0--99  
Delay+reverb effect parameters (parameter type: DELAY+REVERB)  
For effect types 25--28 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following five parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Delay Time  
3. Feedback  
4. Delay Bal  
5. Rev Time  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the delay time: Range: 1--230 ms  
Adjust the number of delay repeats. Range: 0--99  
Adjust the delay balance. Range: 0--99  
Adjust the length of reverberation. Range: 0.1--9.9 seconds  
Delay effect parameters (parameter type: DELAY)  
For effect types 29 and 30 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following five parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Delay Time  
3. Feedback  
4. Hi Ratio  
5. Filter  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the delay time. Range: 1--680 ms  
Adjust the number of delay repeats. Range: 0--99  
Adjust the decay ratio of the high frequencies. Range: 0--10  
Adjust the tone of the delay sound. Range: L9~L1, OFF, H1~H9  
*
*
L1~L9 = LPF (larger numbers will lower the cutoff frequency)  
H1~H9 = HPF (larger numbers will raise the cutoff frequency)  
BPM delay effect parameters (parameter type: BPM DELAY)  
For effect types 31 and 32 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following five parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. BPM  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the BPM. Range: 30--250 bpm  
3. Note  
Select the note value for the delay. Range: 24, 16, 8T, 16...8, 4T, 8., 4, 2T, 4., 2, 2., 1  
*
24 = 16th note sextuplets, 16 = 16th notes, 8T = 8th note triplets, 16. = dotted sixteenth notes,  
8 = 8th notes, 4T = quarter note triplets, 8. = dotted eighth notes,  
4 = quarter notes, 2T = half-note triplets, 4. = dotted quarter notes, 2 = half notes  
* The "." shown in the ninth character of the LCD indicates a dotted note.  
* The "T" shown in the ninth character of the LCD indicates a triplet.  
Adjust the number of delay repeats. Range: 0--99 (100 steps in increments of 1)  
Adjust the tone of the delay sound. Range: L9~L1, OFF, H1~H9  
4. Feedback  
5. Filter  
*
*
L1~L9 = LPF (larger numbers will lower the cutoff frequency)  
H1~H9 = HPF (larger numbers will raise the cutoff frequency)  
Short delay effect parameters (parameter type: SHORT DELAY)  
For effect type 33 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following five parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Delay Time  
3. Feedback  
4. Hi Ratio  
5. Filter  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the delay time. Range: 0.1--9.9 ms, 10--99 ms, 100--200 ms  
Adjust the number of delay repeats. Range: 0--99  
Adjust the decay ratio of the high frequencies. Range: 0--10  
Adjust the tone of the delay sound. Range: L9~L1, OFF, H1~H9  
*
*
L1~L9 = LPF (larger numbers will lower the cutoff frequency)  
H1~H9 = HPF (larger numbers will raise the cutoff frequency)  
Doubling effect parameters (parameter type: DOUBLING)  
For effect type 34 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following four parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Lch Delay  
3. Rch Delay  
4. Filter  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the delay time of the L channel. Range: 0.1--9.9 ms, 10--99 ms, 100--200 ms  
Adjust the delay time of the R channel. Range: 0.1--9.9 ms, 10--99ms, 100--200 ms  
Adjust the tone of the delay sound. Range: L9~L1, OFF, H1~H9  
*
*
L1~L9 = LPF (larger numbers will lower the cutoff frequency)  
H1~H9 = HPF (larger numbers will raise the cutoff frequency)  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Chorus effect parameters (parameter type: CHORUS)  
For effect type 35 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following five parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Depth  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the chorus depth. Range: 0--99  
3. Double Time  
4. Double Lvl  
5. Filter  
Adjust the time difference of the doubling effect. Range: 0--99  
Adjust the volume of the doubling effect. Range: 0--99  
Adjust the tone of the delay sound. Range: L9~L1, OFF, H1~H9  
* L1~L9 = LPF (larger numbers will lower the cutoff frequency)  
* H1~H9 = HPF (larger numbers will raise the cutoff frequency)  
Flanger effect parameters (parameter type: FLANGE)  
For effect type 36 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following five parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Rate  
3. Depth  
4. Mod Delay  
5. Feedback  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the speed of modulation. Range: 0.01--2.00 Hz  
Adjust the depth of modulation. Range: 0--99  
Adjust the modulation delay. Range: 0--200  
Adjust the number of modulation repeats. Range: 0--99  
Mono pitch effect parameters (parameter type: MONO PITCH)  
For effect type 37 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following four parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Pitch  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the amount of pitch shift. Range: -24--0--+24  
*
+/-12 is one octave. +/-24 is two octaves.  
Make fine adjustments to the amount of pitch shift. Range: -50--0--+50  
+50 is a semitone sharp. -50 is a semitone flat.  
Select the processing method. Range: 1--3  
3. Adjust  
4. Mode  
*
Delay pitch effect parameters (parameter type: DELAY PITCH)  
For effect type 38 of the preceding "Effect type" table, the following five parameters can be adjusted.  
1. Eff Level  
2. Pitct  
Adjust the effect return level: 0~99  
Adjust the amount of pitch shift. Range: -24--0--+24  
*
+/-12 is one octave. +/-24 is two octaves.  
Make fine adjustments to the amount of pitch shift. Range: -50--0--+50  
+50 is a semitone sharp. -50 is a semitone flat.  
3. Adjust  
*
4. Delay Time  
5. Feedback  
Adjust the delay time until the pitch-shifted sound is heard. Range: 0--500 ms  
Adjust the number of delay repeats. Range: 0--99  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Scene memory  
The VF80 provides 100 Scene memories (S00 to S99) for each program. You can store a set of desired parameter  
settings to each memory. Items to be stored include all parameters set by mix parameter editing functions, as  
well as all track fader levels. In addition to 100 Scene memories, the VF80 also provides 10 Temporary memories  
(T00 to T09) that can be used with all programs in common. Note that all settings stored in Temporary memories  
disappear when turning off the power.  
You can give a desired title (name) with up to 16 alphanumeric or symbolic characters to each Scene/Temporary  
memory. (Note that up to 11 characters can be shown on the display.)  
Enter the desired scene name by using the [JOG] dial  
for selecting a character and using the [CURSOR / ]  
3
Storing the current scene  
keys for moving the editing (flashing) point.  
You can specify a scene name with up to 16 alphanu-  
meric or symbolic characters and can see up to 14 char-  
acters on the display. The following characters can be  
entered:  
You can store the current scene (settings) to a Scene  
or Temporary memory by using the following proce-  
dure.  
<Hint>  
Scene memories (shown as S00 through S99 on the list)  
are retained even if the power is turned off, while Tem-  
porary memories (shown as T00 through T09 on the list)  
disappear when the power is turned off, though they do  
not disappear when changing the program.  
If you want to store a Temporary memory to a Scene  
memory (S00 to S99), recall the temporary number be-  
fore turning off the power and store the settings to the  
desired Scene memory number.  
A to Z, a to z, 0 to 9, + - * / # & ! ? ( ) [ ] < > : . , etc.  
After completing the scene name entry, press the  
[TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
The display changes to the Normal display of the pro-  
gram whose scene name has just been set.  
4
Press the [SCENE] key.  
1
The display shows the screen for selecting the desired  
scene number.  
Recalling a scene  
You can recall the settings stored in Scene or Tempo-  
rary memories.  
<Cautions>  
• If the "Fader recall On/Off setting" menu described  
later is set to "OFF", when recalling a desired scene  
memory, fader settings are not recalled, while "Scene  
Recalled Fader RCL OFF" is momentarily shown on the  
screen.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired scene number  
2
to which you want to store the current settings, and  
press the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while holding down  
the [SHIFT] key. (In the following example, "S01" is  
• If the "Fader recall On/Off setting" menu is set to "ON",  
regardless of the current physical positions of track  
and master faders, the audio is output at the fader  
positions when they were stored. We suggest you to  
turn the monitor volume down when recalling a scene  
memory to prevent an accidentally accessing high-  
volume sound.  
selected.)  
The scene name of the program which you worked with  
before entering the scene memory mode is duplicated  
to the name of the selected scene number, whose  
leftmost character flashes, showing that it can be ed-  
ited.  
Press the [SCENE] key.  
1
The display shows the screen for selecting the scene  
number.  
Flashing  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired scene number  
to be recalled.  
2
3
Fader adjust  
After recalling a scene, the recalled fader level usu-  
ally does not match the current physical fader posi-  
tion, you can move the physical faders to match the  
current fader positions of the scene.  
The following description is assumed that "Fader re-  
call setting" of the setup mode is set to "Trk & Mst."  
Press the [SETUP/F1] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
The selected scene is recalled and the display changes  
to the Normal display.  
Deleting a scene  
Press the [SCENE/FADER] key while holding down the  
1
[SHIFT] key.  
You can delete an unnecessary Scene or Temporary  
memory by using the following procedure.  
The display shows the fader setting screen.  
The fader icon changes according to the relation be-  
tween the physical fader position and recalled fader  
position, as show below.  
<Notes>  
• You cannot delete the memory in scene number 00.  
If you select scene number 00 and try to delete the  
memory, "DELETE" does not appear on the display.  
• You cannot undo deleting a scene.  
Be sure not to select a wrong scene number to be  
deleted.  
Press the [SCENE] key.  
1
The display shows the scene number/title list.  
•The current physical fader po-  
sition is lower than the recalled  
position.  
Select a memory to be deleted using the [JOG] dial.  
2
Press the [UNDO/REDO/F3] key while holding down  
3
the [SHIFT] key.  
Themessageaskingforconfirmationtodeletethescene  
appears and "Sure?" flashes.  
•The current physical fader po-  
sition matches the recalled po-  
sition.  
•The current physical fader po-  
sition is higher than the recalled  
position.  
To cancel to delete the mark, press the [EXIT/NO] key  
now.  
Move a physical fader manually to match the recalled  
(scene memory) position.  
2
3
Flashing  
After adjusting all the fader positions, press the [EXIT/  
NO] key.  
<Note>  
If you recall a scene when "Fader recall setting" of the  
setup mode is set to "OFF", the current physical fader  
positions are valid.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while holding down the  
4
[RECORD] key.  
The selected memory is deleted and the scene name  
changes to "[Un-defined]", showing that no memory is  
stored.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
5
The display returns to the Normal screen.  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Scene sequence  
Using the scene sequence function, you can recall desired scene memories at the desired mark positions during  
playback. For example, you can recall scene memory 02 at "Bar 17/Beat 1" and scene memory 04 at "Bar 25/Beat  
1", etc. To execute the scene sequence function, you must first assign scene (or temporary) memories to marks  
in the mark map. If you set the timebase to Bar/Beat/Clk, you can assign scene memories to be recalled to the  
musical positions (Bar/Beat/Clk numbers). Of course, you may set the timebase to ABS.  
Highlight "Non" using the [CURSOR / ] keys, and  
then select the desired scene number to be assigned  
to the mark using the [JOG] dial.  
<Note>  
3
You must store data to scene memories before assigning  
to the mark map.  
When selecting a scene number which holds data, its  
scene title is also shown below the scene number.  
Assigning scene memories to the mark map  
In the following description, we assume that the  
timebase is set to Bar/Beat/Clk.  
While the recorder is stopped, press the [SCENE SEQ/  
1
MAP] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
The screen shows the mark map, in which the current  
marks are listed.  
In the mark map example below, only scene memory 00  
is assigned to mark 00. ("Non" means that no memory is  
assigned to the corresponding mark.)  
Mark title  
Scene number  
<Hint>  
Scene title  
You can view mark titles instead of mark positions  
(in bar/beat/clock base or ABS time base) in the mark  
map. Pressing the [TIME BASE SEL] key while the mark  
map screen is shown switches mark positions and  
mark titles.  
After selecting the scene number, press the [ENTER/  
YES] key.  
Repeat steps 1 through 4 to assign scene numbers to  
other marks.  
4
In the example below, several scene numbers are as-  
signed to marks and you are ready for executing the  
scene sequence function described later.  
Select the desired mark using the [JOG] dial, and then  
2
press the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while holding down  
the [SHIFT] key.  
The display shows the screen for editing the selected  
mark.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key after assigning all desired  
scenes to marks.  
5
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mixer Functions  
Deleting a mark from the mark map  
Executing the scene sequence  
You can delete an unnecessary mark from the mark  
map.  
If you start playback while the scene sequence func-  
tion is active (ON), the scenes will be recalled accord-  
ing to the mark map.  
<Note>  
You cannot delete mark 00.  
<Note>  
When executing the scene sequence, the fader positions  
may be recalled or not according to the fader recall mode  
setting in the setup mode (the default is "OFF").  
For example, if you set the fader recall mode to "ON", both  
the track and master faders are automatically recalled  
every time the current scene changes.  
On the contrary, if you set the fader recall mode to "OFF"  
(the default mode), fader positions are not recalled so you  
can manually control fader positions as you like.  
We suggest you to make sure to set the fader recall mode  
suitably for your work before executing the scene se-  
quence. See "Fader recall mode setting" on page 133 for de-  
tails.  
While the VF80 is stopped, press the [SCENE SEQ/  
1
MAP] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
The screen shows the mark map.  
Highlight the desired mark using the [JOG] dial.  
2
Pressthe[UNDO/REDO/F3]keywhileholdingdownthe  
3
[SHIFT] key.  
The message asking for confirmation to delete the mark  
appears and "Sure?" flashes.  
To cancel to delete the mark, press the [EXIT/NO] key  
now.  
<Screen appearances during playback>  
The following show the screen appearances during play-  
back with the mark map in which scene number 02 (with  
the title "BBBB") is assigned to "Bar 12, Beat 1" and scene  
number 06 (with the title "CCCC") is assigned to "Bar 20,  
Beat 4."  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while holding down the  
4
[RECORD] key.  
The map is deleted and the following marks are renum-  
bered.  
Scene sequence on/off selection  
You can turn on or off the scene sequence function  
for selecting whether or not performing the scene  
sequence function using the mark map.  
The unit starts playback from "Bar -2, Beat 1" with  
the settings stored in scene number 00 (Init Mix).  
While theVF80 is stopped,press the [SCENE SEQ] key.  
1
The [SCENE SEQ] key lights in green, showing that the  
scene sequence function is active (ON).  
Each time you press the [SCENE SEQ] key, ON and OFF  
alternates.  
Theunitrecallsscenenumber02(BBBB)at"Bar  
12, Beat 1" and continues playback.  
When turning on the scene sequence function, "SCENE  
SQ:ON"appearsmomentarilyontheNormalscreenand  
then the scene number is highlighted.  
When turning off the scene sequence function, "SCENE  
SQ: OFF" appears momentarily on the Normal screen  
and then the highlighted scene number returns to the  
Normal screen.  
The unit recalls scene number 06 (CCCC) at  
"Bar 20, Beat 4" and continues playback.  
<Note>  
The effect preset may not be changed while the  
scene sequence function is active!  
Effect presets of the internal effect processor are clas-  
sified into three types; ambience/delay type (No. 1  
through 28), modulation/pitch type (No. 29 through  
36), pitch type (No. 37 and 38) and distortion/simu-  
lation type (No. 39 through 44).  
Note that the scene sequence function does not re-  
call an effect preset whose type is different from the  
current one. This is to avoid momentary audio mut-  
ing, and is not a malfunction. The other mix param-  
eters of the scene can be recalled even if it includes  
an effect preset whose type is different from the cur-  
rent one.  
Highlighted  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Recorder Functions  
This chapter describes various recorder functions.  
Cueing  
The cueing function allows you to monitor audio at higher or lower speed.  
• Rotating the [JOG/SHUTTLE] dial clockwise moves the  
Cueing with the [F FWD]/[REWIND] keys  
position to the forward direction, while rotating the dial  
counter-clockwise moves the position to the backward  
direction.  
By pressing the [F FWD] or [REWIND] key during play-  
back, you can monitor (cue) the sound at 3 times the  
normal speed.  
• According to the rotating degree, the cueing speed varies  
among 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x, 32x, and 64x.  
The current cueing speed is shown on the screen.  
Press the [PLAY] key to start playback.  
1
• As long as holding down the [SHIFT] key, shuttle cueing  
continues even if you release the [JOG/SHUTTLE] dial.  
Press the [F FWD] or [REWIND] key during playback.  
2
TheVF80 is "cueing" in the forward direction at 64x the normal speed.  
TheVF80 is "cueing" in the backward direction at 64x the normal speed.  
TheVF80 is still.  
The VF80 starts "cueing" at 3 times the normal speed,  
while "FWD" or "RWD" appears on the screen.  
TheVF80 is "cueing" in the forward direction.  
TheVF80 is "cueing" in the backward direction.  
To return to the normal playback,press the [PLAY] key.  
3
To return to the normal playback,press the [PLAY] key.  
3
Shuttle cueing  
<Remember!>  
Once the data is rewound to the beginning of a pro-  
gram (ABS 0), playback starts from the beginning of  
the program, regardless of pressing the [SHIFT] key.  
When reaching the end of a program (ABS: 23H 59M  
59S), the program stops and the [PLAY] hey flashes.  
During playback, "shuttle cueing" is possible at the  
speed between 1 and 64 times the normal speed.  
Press the [PLAY] key to start playback.  
1
Rotatethe[JOG/SHUTTLE]dialwhileholdingdownthe  
2
[SHIFT] key.  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Digital scrubbing  
Storing the digital scrub point  
You can store the scrub point to the Start, End or To  
point for track editing functions (such as Copy, Move,  
Paste and Erase), or the auto-punch in point.  
Digital scrubbing can be done between 0x and 1x  
speed without changing the pitch while the VF80 is  
stopped.  
You can scrub audio track by track. The level enve-  
lope of the scrub track is shown on the screen, allow-  
ing you to locate the beginning of a song or interval  
of songs easily.  
To store the scrub point to the Start point:  
Press the [SETUP/F1] key while holding down the [SHIFT]  
key.  
"Edit Start Point Stored!" is shown briefly and then the  
scrub point is stored to the Start point for track editing.  
Furthermore, you can use the position located by  
digital scrubbing as an edit point for the track editing  
or auto-punch in/out.  
Performing digital scrubbing  
While stopped, press the [WAVE FORM SCRUB] key.  
1
The VF80 enters the scrub mode, and the display shows  
the screen below.  
To store the scrub point to the End point:  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while holding down  
the [SHIFT] key.  
"Edit End Point Stored!" is shown briefly and then the scrub  
point is stored to the End point for track editing.  
Press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key for the  
2
track you are going to scrub.  
The level envelope of audio recorded on the selected  
track is shown. When the VF80 is stopped, "<STILL>" is  
also shown.  
To store the scrub point to theTo point:  
Press the [UNDO/REDO/F3] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
"EditTo Point Stored!" is shown briefly and then the scrub  
point is stored to the To point, which can be used as the  
starting point of Paste or the auto-punch In point.  
By rotating the [JOG] dial, you can scrub audio of the  
3
selected track.  
The vertical line in the center shows the current posi-  
tion, and you can hear scrubbing audio from this posi-  
tion to either the forward or backward direction.  
When rotating the [JOG] dial clockwise, "Scrub >" is  
shown. When rotating the [JOG] dial counter-clockwise,  
"< Scrub" is shown.  
The cursor (the vertical line) moves while scrubbing,  
while the time value (or bar/beat) of the current posi-  
tion is shown in realtime.  
• After storing the point, press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The display returns to the Normal screen that was shown  
when finishing scrubbing.  
<Hint>  
• You can also store the point by pressing the [ENTER/  
YES] key after highlighting “START”, “END” or “TO” by  
using the [CURSOR ] or [CURSOR ] key.  
• By pressing the [| / MARK] key while holding down  
the [SHIFT] key, you can store the scrub point to a mark  
memory.  
current scrubbing position  
If you want to scrub another track, repeat steps 2 and 3.  
4
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Vari Pitch  
You can alter the playback or recording speed of the recorder within +/- 6.0 % range in 0.1 % increments/dec-  
rements by using the vari pitch function. With the vari pitch function, the pitch changes according to the speed.  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
PHONES  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
MUTE  
PLAY  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
5
4
3
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
SEL  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
PITCH  
LOOP  
EDIT  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
3
2
1
"ON" or "OFF" (of the vari pitch function) is also shown  
on the screen.  
Turning on or off the vari pitch function  
Press the [VARI PITCH/EDIT] key.  
1
Use the [JOG] dial to enter the pitch value.  
The key lights up in green, showing the vari pitch func-  
tion is active.  
4
Press the [EXIT/NO] key to return to the Normal screen.  
5
Press the [VARI PITCH/EDIT] key again.  
The key turns off, showing the vari pitch function is not  
active.  
2
<Notes>  
• Even if the pitch value is set to 0.0 % (no speed  
change), pressing the [VARI PITCH] key turns on the  
vari pitch function.  
In such a condition, the function is active but the  
speed is not changed.  
<Note>  
You can turn on or off the vari pitch function while  
stopped or during playback, however, you cannot turn  
on or off the function during recording.  
Setting the speed  
• The vari pitch function automatically turns off by  
carrying out any of the following.  
You can adjust the speed while stopped or during  
playback, however, you cannot adjust the speed dur-  
ing recording. If you adjust the speed during play-  
backwiththevaripitchfunctionactive, youcanmoni-  
tor the result of speed (pitch) change while adjusting.  
1.Turning the power off and then on. (The pitch  
value is also reset to 0.0 %.)  
2.Setting the slave mode to "On" in the setup mode.  
(The pitch value is retained.)  
Note that you cannot turn on the vari pitch  
function when the slave mode is "On".  
While stopped or during playback, press the [VARI  
1
PITCH/EDIT] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
The current pitch value is highlighted, showing that the  
value can be edited.  
3.Setting the digital input to "On" in the setup mode  
("DIGI IN" is shown on the screen).  
Note that you cannot turn on the vari pitch  
function when the digital input is selected.  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Loop Function  
Using the loop function, you can repeat the desired part between the Start and End points.  
By using the loop function together with the punch in/out or training mode, you can concentrate on playing  
without the need for operating the VF80.  
Current time (or musical position)  
<Loop Function>  
START point  
END point  
Playback  
After locating the Start point, playback starts automatically.  
The Start point is set to the captured time (or musical  
position), which is shown here.  
At the point where you want to set the End point,press  
the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while holding down the  
3
When the playback position reaches the End point,  
the recorder locates to the Start point automatically.  
[SHIFT] key.  
"End Point Stored!" briefly appears and the End point is  
set to the captured point.  
Current time (or musical position)  
Setting the Start and End points  
TherearefollowingthreemethodsforsettingtheStart  
and End points.  
1. Capturing the current position "On-the-fly"  
2. Editing the time (or musical position) via the screen  
3. Setting by marks  
The End point is set to the captured time (or musical po-  
sition), which is shown here.  
Capturing the current position "on-the-fly"  
<Note>  
The Start point must be earlier than the End point.  
Otherwise, the loop function cannot be performed.  
While stopped or running, you can set the Start or End  
point at the point you capture.  
Press the [LOOP/EDIT] key while holding down the  
1
[SHIFT] key.  
The display shows the loop screen in which you can set  
the Start and End points.  
Editing the position via the screen  
In the following description, the recorder is assumed  
to be stopped and the ABS time base is selected.  
Current time (or musical position)  
Press the [LOOP/EDIT] key while holding down the  
1
[SHIFT] key.  
The display shows the loop screen in which you can set  
the Start and End points.  
At the point where you want to set the Start point,press  
2
the[SETUP/F1]keywhileholdingdownthe[SHIFT]key.  
"Start Point Stored!" briefly appears and the Start point  
is set to the captured point.  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
ToedittheStartpoint,pressthe[ENTER/YES]keywhile  
"Start Point" value is highlighted.  
2
The "seconds" value flashes, showing that it can be ed-  
ited.  
A mark is shown.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The mark shown on the Start point value field starts  
flashing.  
3
The "seconds" value flashes.  
Use the [CURSOR / ] keys to move the flashing value,  
and use the [JOG] dial to edit the value.  
3
Youcanalsousethe[CURSOR  
/
] keystoeditthevalue.  
Flashing  
After editing all values, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display returns to the similar screen shown in step  
1 above, in which the Start point is set to the edited time.  
4
5
To edit the End point,use the [CURSOR ] key to high-  
light the "End point" value and carry out the same  
operations as steps 2 through 4 above.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired mark and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The Start point is set to the selected mark, while the  
display returns to the similar screen shown in step 2  
above.  
4
5
<Note>  
To edit the End point,use the [CURSOR ] key to high-  
light the "End point" value and carry out the same  
operations as steps 3 through 4 above.  
As also noted in "capturing the current position on-the-  
fly", the Start point must be earlier than the End point.  
Otherwise, the loop function cannot be performed.  
The selected mark is set to the End point.  
<Hint>  
When rehearsing the auto punch in/out, if you also  
activate the loop function in which the Start point is  
set to a point a little bit earlier than the In point while  
the End point is set to a point a little bit later than the  
Out point, you can rehearse the auto punch in/out  
repeatedly as many times as you like.  
Setting the Start and End points by marks  
You can set the Start and End points by marks.  
Theloopfunctionisalsousefulwhenyoumakeaprac-  
tice using the training mode.  
<Note>  
This method only can be used when any mark point is  
already stored.  
Carrying out the loop playback  
While stopped, press the [LOOP/EDIT] key while hold-  
1
Once setting the Start and End points, you can carry  
out the loop function.  
ing down the [SHIFT] key.  
The display shows the loop screen in which you can set  
the Start and End points.  
Press the [LOOP] key to illuminate the key.  
1
The loop function is now active.  
Each time you press the [LOOP] key, On and Off of the  
loop function alternates.  
StartplaybackfromthepointearlierthantheStartpoint.  
2
When the recorder reaches the End point, it automati-  
cally locates to the Start point and starts playback from  
that point. The recorder continues loop playback until  
stopping the recorder.  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL] key.  
2
Both the Start point and End point value fields show a  
mark (number and name).  
To stop loop playback, press the [LOOP] key to turn off  
3
the lamp and press the [STOP] key.  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Program  
The VF80 can have up to 99 programs (P01 through P99) and usually each program manages one song.  
You can make recording against each program or playback materials recorded on each program.  
This section describe program-related operations.  
Note that you may use the program with the tentative  
title ("#0002" in this example) if you do not need to en-  
ter the desired one. Anyway, you may also enter/edit  
the title later by the procedure described in "Editing a  
program title" on page 62.  
To use the program with the tentative title, press the  
[EXIT/NO] key. To put the desired title, see the following.  
Creating a new program  
When formatting a hard disk, a program (P01) is au-  
tomatically created.  
To create a new program, follow the procedure below  
while the recorder is stopped and the display shows  
the Normal screen.  
<Note>  
<How to enter a desired title>  
The initial settings for a new program are copied from the  
setting of the current program.  
Therefore, if you want to make a new program with the  
same settings as an existing program, bring up the pro-  
gram before creating a new program.  
• Rotate the [JOG] dial (or [CURSOR  
/
] keys)  
to select a character for the blinking point from  
among those listed below.  
• Use the [CURSOR / ] keys to move the blinking  
point.  
Press the [TRACK EDIT/PGM] key while holding down  
1
the [SHIFT] key.  
The screen for selecting, renaming or deleting a pro-  
gram appears. (The screen example below shows the  
initial condition where only Program 01 exists.)  
<Hint>  
When selecting a character, rotating the [JOG] dial  
while holding down the [SHIFT] key jumps among  
characters surrounded with the box above.  
This function will allow you to save time for select-  
ing a desired character.  
Use the [JOG] dial to highlight "P02 [New Program]"  
2
and then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
When highlighting "P02 [New Program]", only high-  
lighted "SELECT" is shown at the bottom of the screen.  
Pressing the [ENTER/YES] key creates a new program  
(P02 in this example) with the tentative title whose  
leftmost character ("#" in this example) is highlighted.  
In this condition, you can enter the program title by  
following the procedure described in "<How to enter a  
desired title> below.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key after entering the title.  
The title is set.  
3
4
Press the [EXIT/NO] (or [STOP]) key.  
The setup mode exits and the display shows the Nor-  
mal screen of the newly created program.  
<Hint>  
• When creating a new program, the next program  
number to the highest program number in the  
existing programs is assigned.  
If there is only one program (P01), Program 02  
(P02) will be created. If there is five programs (P01  
through P05), Program 06 (P06) will be created.  
• Creating a new program consumes a small amount  
of the recordable disk space. Also note that when  
the recordable disk space is not enough, you  
cannot create a new program.  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Press the [TRACK EDIT/PGM] key while holding down  
the [SHIFT] key.  
1
Selecting a program  
Thescreenforselecting, renamingordeletingaprogram  
appears. In the screen, all existing program numbers  
and titles are shown.  
When more than one program exists on the disk, you  
have to select the desired program before starting  
operations for recording, playback or editing.  
Selectthedesiredprogrambyfollowingtheprocedure  
below while the recorder is stopped and the display  
shows the Normal screen.  
Press the [TRACK EDIT/PGM] key while holding down  
1
the [SHIFT] key.  
Thescreenforselecting, renamingordeletingaprogram  
appears. In the screen, all existing program numbers  
and titles are shown.  
Use the [JOG] dial to highlight the program to be de-  
leted and then press the [UNDO/REDO/F3] key while  
holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
2
The screen shows "Delete! Sure?", asking you confirm.  
Use the [JOG] dial to highlight the desired program and  
2
then press the [SETUP/F1] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
<Hint>  
Youmayusethe[CURSOR ] tohighlight"DELETE"and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key to bring up the screen  
above, instead of pressing the [UNDO/REDO/F3] key  
while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while holding down the  
[RECORD] key.  
The selected (highlighted) program is deleted, and the  
following programs in the list move up.  
3
4
Deleting a program  
You can delete an unnecessary program individually.  
To make recording or editing, a certain amount of disk  
space is needed. By deleting unnecessary programs,  
the available disk space increases.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key to switch to the Normal screen.  
The previous program of the deleted program is se-  
lected.  
<Notes>  
• When only one program (P01) exists, if you try to  
delete the program, the data in the program is deleted  
but P01 remains.  
Editing a program title  
You can edit a program title anytime by following the  
procedure below.  
Note that you can also enter a program title in the  
process of creating a new program as mentioned ear-  
lier.  
• For example, when five programs (P01 through P05)  
exist, if you delete P03, it looks like P05 is deleted. This  
is because the program numbers higher than 03 move  
down. In other words, P04 and P05 become P03 and  
P04 respectively.  
Press the [TRACK EDIT/PGM] key while holding down  
1
P05  
P03  
P04  
P02  
P01  
the [SHIFT] key.  
Thescreenforselecting, renamingordeletingaprogram  
appears. In the screen, all existing program numbers  
and titles are shown.  
P03 is deleted.  
P03  
P04  
P02  
P01  
Notethatyoucannotundoorredodeletingtheprogram.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
You can put a title name with up to 16 characters from  
among those listed below.  
When selecting a character, rotating the [JOG] dial while  
holding down the [SHIFT] key jumps among characters  
surrounded with the box below.  
Use the [JOG] dial to highlight (select) the desired pro-  
gram and then press the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while  
holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
Now you can edit the title of the selected program.  
The leftmost character of the selected program is flash-  
ing.  
2
Flashing  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key after editing/entering the  
title.  
The edited/entered title is set.  
<Hint>  
4
5
You may use the [CURSOR ] to highlight "RENAME"  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key to bring up the screen  
above, instead of pressing the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key  
while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] (or [STOP]) key.  
The display returns to the Normal screen.  
Use the [CURSOR / ] keys to move the flashing (ed-  
3
iting) point and use the [JOG] dial (or [CURSOR  
keys) to select a character for the flashing point.  
/
]
Track editing  
Because the VF80 uses a 3.5-inch E-IDE hard disk as the recording media, you can make non-linear and non-  
destructive audio editing by track effectively.  
Copy & Paste  
Move & Paste  
The Copy & Paste function allows you to copy track  
data of a desired part and paste it to a desired part of  
the same or different track.  
The Move & Paste function allows you to move track  
data of a desired part and paste it to a desired part of  
the same or different track.  
The copied data remains after pasting the data, so you  
can paste the data as many times as required.  
The copy & paste function is useful when using the  
same musical part repeatedly in a song.  
Unlike the copy & paste operation, the moved data  
does not remain in the original position.  
Copy & paste within the same track.  
Move & paste within the same track.  
A
A
A'  
A'  
A'  
Copy & paste between different track.  
Move & paste between different track.  
A'  
START Point END Point  
START Point END Point  
TO Point  
TO Point  
<Notes>  
• Copy data (or Move data) is replaced with the new data every time the copy (or move) operation is carried out.  
• Note that copy data changes if you paste the copy data to the original data.  
• The copy & paste (or move & paste) editing is performed on the current program. Therefore, do not change the current  
program until the editing operations are completed.  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
The corresponding [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys of  
the source track(s) light in green, while the correspond-  
ing [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys of the destination  
track(s) light in red.  
Performing Copy (or Move) & Paste  
Set the Start and End points for the copy (or move)  
1
2
operation andTo point for the paste operation.  
Using the digital scrub function, set the Start, End and  
To points. See "Storing the digital scrub point" for details  
about how to set the points.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key after selecting tracks.  
The display shows the "Point Select" screen as below, in  
which you can view the Start, End and To points set via  
the digital scrub operation.  
6
While the recorder is stopped, press the [TRACK EDIT]  
key.  
The screen for selecting the track edit type appears.  
<Hints>  
On the screen above, you can perform the following  
operations.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select "Copy Paste" (or "Move  
3
Paste") and then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the source  
track(s) and destination track(s).  
1. Editing the Start, End andTo points  
2. Setting the Start andTo points to "ABS 0" and the End point  
to "REC END"  
3. Checking the data to be copied (or moved)  
4. Setting the Start, End andTo points by marks  
or "MovePaste"  
• To edit the Start, End andTo points:  
Highlight the time field of the desired (Start, End orTo) point,  
and then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The "seconds" value starts flashing, showing that you can  
edit it. Use the [CURSOR / ] keys to move the flashing  
value, and use the [JOG] dial to enter a value.  
After entering the desired time, pressing the[ENTER/YES]  
key to store the time data to the point.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the source track(s) from  
which the data is copied (moved).  
Rotating the [JOG] dial changes the options among 1  
through 8, 1&2, 3&4, 5&6, 7&8, 1-6, and 1-8.  
4
5
To set the Start andTo points to "ABS 0" and the End  
point to "REC END":  
Press the [SETUP/F1] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
"ALL OFF" changes to "ALL ON", and the Start and To  
points are set to "ABS 0", while the End point is set to "REC  
END" point. This function is useful when you copy (or  
move) all track data (from "ABS 0" to "REC END") to dif-  
ferent track(s).  
Use the [CURSOR ] key to highlight (and flashes) the  
right field, and use the [JOG] dial to select the destina-  
tion track(s) to which the data is copied (moved).  
Rotating the [JOG] dial changes the options as below  
depending on the track(s) you selected in step 4.  
To check (monitor) the data to be copied (or moved)  
[Source Play function]:  
Source track(s)  
Destination options  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
The display shows the "Source Play" screen as shown  
below and the recorder starts playback of the data to be  
copied (or moved).  
a mono track (1 through 8)  
a pair of tracks  
1-6  
1-8  
1 through 8  
1&2, 3&4, 5&6, and 7&8  
1-6 only  
1-8 only  
In the example below, data on tracks 3&4 is copied (or  
moved) and pasted onto tracks 7&8.  
Youcanhearaudiobymovingupthecorrespondingtrack  
fader. After checking audio, press the [STOP] key.  
The display returns to the screen shown before perform-  
ing the Source play function.  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Pressthe[UNDO/REDO/F3]keywhileholdingdownthe  
[SHIFT] key.  
The copy & paste (or move & paste) function is per-  
formed. When finished, "Completed!" appears on the  
screen.  
8
To set editing points by marks:  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL] key.  
Each data field for the Start, End and To points changes  
to show the current option by mark as shown below.  
Use the [CURSOR  
/
] keys to highlight the field for the  
desired point, and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The field starts flashing.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired mark and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
<Hint>  
You may use the [CURSOR >] to highlight "EXE" and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key to perform the function, instead of  
pressing the [UNDO/REDO/F3] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
The point is set to the selected mark.  
<Note>  
<Note>  
Thisoperationcanbeperformedonlywhenanymark  
is set. When no mark is set, "00:ABS 0" is the one and  
only option for each point.  
The copy & paste (or move & paste) operation cannot be  
performed when there is not enough disk space to per-  
form the undo and redo operations. If you try to perform  
the paste operation when there is not enough disk space,  
The display will show "OverTime!", as well as the short  
time.  
In such a case, shorten the copy (or move) data by the  
amount more than the displayed time or delete unnec-  
essary sections or programs to keep the enough space,  
and then try to paste again.  
Use the [CURSOR ] key to highlight the field ("01"  
above) for the number of times for repeat paste, and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
"01" starts flashing and you can now enter the number  
of times for repeat paste.  
6
Undo/redo of Copy & Paste  
You can undo a copy & paste or move & paste opera-  
tion, as well as redo it (undo the undo operation).  
• By pressing the [UNDO/REDO] key after completing the  
copy & paste (or move & paste) operation, you can  
return the track(s) to the condition before performing  
the copy & paste (or move & paste) operation.  
• By pressing the [UNDO/REDO] key just after  
performingtheundooperation, youcanundotheundo  
operation and return the track(s) to the condition  
after performing the copy & paste (or move & paste)  
operation.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired number and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
You can select any number between "01" and "99".  
7
<Note>  
Basically you can select the number of times for repeat  
paste between 1 and 99, however, if the recordable space  
of the hark disk is limited, you may not be able to select  
the desired number. The VF80 automatically calculate  
the available space and limit the number of times to the  
appropriate value.  
Note the following for performing the undo/redo opera-  
tion.  
<Notes>  
You can undo or redo only when the recorder is stopped.  
If you carry out any of the following after performing the  
copy & paste (or move & paste) operation, you cannot  
undo/redo the copy & paste (or move & paste) opera-  
tion.  
When setting the number of times for repeat paste to 02,  
the copy & paste function is performed as below.  
Copy & paste within the same track.  
1.Making a new recording  
2.Performing a new editing  
A
A'  
A''  
A''  
3.Letting the recorder run in playback (or recording)  
mode and pass through the auto punch-in point while  
the auto punch mode is active  
4.Turning off the power of the VF80  
5.Performing any of the program operations (select,  
rename or delete).  
Copy & paste between different track.  
A'  
START Point END Point  
TO Point  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the track(s) to be erased.  
Rotating the [JOG] dial changes the options among 1  
through 8, 1&2, 3&4, 5&6, 7&8, 1-6, and 1-8.  
The corresponding [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key(s)  
of the selected track(s) light in red.  
4
5
Erasing track data  
You can erase a desired part of track data. You can  
select a track or tracks (of which you are going to erase  
data) from among each individual track, each pair of  
tracks, 1-6 and 1-8.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key after selecting the track(s).  
The screen shows the Start and End points.  
REC END  
ABS 0  
Erase  
START Point END Point  
<Notes for the erase function>  
• When all eight tracks (1 through 8) are recorded, if you  
erase a part of the chosen track, only the erased part  
becomes silent (no audio) and the following material  
does not move advance to fill the gap.  
Therefore, the REC END point remains the same.  
However, if you erase a part between the chosen point  
(=Start point) and the REC END point (=End point) of  
all tracks, the REC END point moves advance.  
<Hint>  
On the screen above, you can perform the following  
operations.  
1. Editing the Start and End points  
2. Setting the Start point to "ABS 0" and the End point to "REC  
END"  
3. Checking the data to be erased  
4. Setting the Start and End points by marks  
• The erase operations are performed on the current  
program. Therefore, do not change the current pro  
gram until all the operations are completed.  
To edit the Start and End points:  
Highlight the time field of a desired (Start or End) point, and  
then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The "seconds" value starts flashing, showing that you can  
Erasing  
edit it. Use the [CURSOR  
/
] keys to move the flashing  
Set the Start and End points for the erase operation.  
1
value, and use the [JOG] dial to enter a value.  
After entering the desired time, pressing the [ENTER/YES]  
key to store the time data to the point.  
Using the digital scrub function, set the Start and End  
points. See "Storing the digital scrub point" for details  
about how to set the points.  
To set the Start point to "ABS 0" and the End point to  
"REC END":  
Press the [SETUP/F1] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
"ALL OFF" changes to "ALL ON", and the Start point is set  
to "ABS 0", while the End point is set to "REC END" point.  
This function is useful when you erase all track data.  
While the recorder is stopped,press the [TRACK EDIT]  
2
key.  
The screen for selecting the track edit type appears.  
To check (monitor) the data to be erased [Source Play  
function]:  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL/F2] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
The display shows the "Source Play" screen as shown  
below and the recorder starts playback of the data to be  
erased.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select "Erase" and then press the  
3
[ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the track(s)  
to be erased.  
You can hear audio by moving up the corresponding  
track fader. After checking audio, press the [STOP] key.  
The display returns to the screen shown before perform-  
ing the Source play function.  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
To set editing points by marks:  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL] key.  
Undo/redo of Erase  
You can undo an erase operation, as well as redo it  
(undo the undo operation).  
Each data field for the Start and End points changes to  
show the current option by mark as shown below.  
• By pressing the [UNDO/REDO] key after completing  
the erase operation, you can return the track(s) to the  
condition before performing the erase operation.  
• By pressing the [UNDO/REDO] key just after  
performing the undo operation, you can undo the  
undo operation and return the track(s) to the  
condition after performing the erase operation.  
Use the [CURSOR  
desired point, and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The field starts flashing.  
/
] keys to highlight the field for the  
Note the following for performing the undo/redo op-  
eration.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired mark and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
<Notes>  
The editing point is set to the selected mark.  
You can undo or redo only when the recorder is stopped.  
If you carry out any of the following after performing  
the erase operation, you cannot undo/redo the erase  
operation.  
<Note>  
This operation can be performed only when any mark  
is set. When no mark is set, "00:ABS 0" is the one and  
only option for each point.  
1.Making a new recording  
2.Performing a new editing  
3.Letting the recorder run in playback (or recording)  
mode and pass through the auto punch-in point while  
the auto punch mode is active  
4.Turning off the power of the VF80  
5.Performing any of the program operations (select,  
rename or delete).  
Pressthe[UNDO/REDO/F3]keywhileholdingdownthe  
[SHIFT] key.  
The erase function is performed. When finished, "Com-  
pleted!" appears on the screen.  
6
<Hint>  
You may use the [CURSOR ] to highlight "EXE" and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key to perform the function, instead of  
pressing the [UNDO/REDO/F3] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the source track(s).  
Rotating the [JOG] dial changes the options among  
single tracks (1 through 24), pair tracks (1&2 through  
23&24), 1-8, 9-16 and 17-24.  
3
4
Track Exchange  
The track exchange function allows you to exchange  
tracks (regardless of whether they are real or addi-  
tional tracks) on the program in single track unit, 2-  
track unit or 8-track unit.  
Use the [CURSOR ] key to highlight (and flashes) the  
right field, and use the [JOG] dial to select the destina-  
By using this function, you can exchange tracks not  
only among real tracks but also between real and  
additional tracks, allowing to use tracks effectively.  
For example, by exchanging a recorded real track with  
an empty additional track, you can transfer data on  
a real track to an additional track temporarily, so that  
you can record a new material onto the real track.  
The track exchange function is also used to check the  
REC END point on an additional track.  
tion track(s).  
You can only select the same number of tracks as the  
source track(s) selected in step 3 above.  
For example, if you select a single track in step 3 above,  
you can only select a single track here.  
<Example 1> ExchangingTrack 8 andTrack 24  
One track exchange  
8 track block exchange  
Track 1  
Track 2  
Track 3  
Track 4  
Track 5  
Track 6  
Track 7  
Track 8  
Track 17  
Track 18  
Track 19  
Track 20  
Track 21  
Track 22  
Track 23  
Track 24  
Track 9  
Track 10  
Track 11  
Track 12  
Track 13  
Track 14  
Track 15  
Track 16  
<Example 2> ExchangingTracks 1&2 andTracks 7&8  
2 track block exchange  
8 track block exchange  
<Example 3> ExchangingTracks 1-8 andTracks 17-24  
Performing the track exchange  
While the recorder is stopped,press the [TRACK EDIT]  
key.  
1
The screen for selecting the track edit type appears.  
After selecting tracks, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The track exchange function is performed and the dis-  
play returns to the Normal screen.  
5
Use the [JOG] dial to select "Exchange" and then press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
2
<Note forTrack Exchange>  
If the selected tracks for the left and right fields are re-  
versed, the same track exchange is performed.  
For example, "1-8<->17-24" and "17-24<->1-8" perform the  
same track exchange.  
The setting in which the same track(s) are selected for  
both the left and right fields, such as "1-8<->1-8", is invalid.  
If you press the [ENTER/YES] key with such a setting, the  
display shows the message "Select Err! Hit Any Keys".  
The display shows the screen for selecting the tracks to  
be exchanged. The screen example below shows that  
tracks 01 through 08 and tracks 17 through 24 are ex-  
changed in 8-track unit.  
The left field shows the source track(s), while the right  
fields shows the destination track(s).  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Editing Marks  
Thissectiondescribeshowtoeditmarks, assumingthatmorethanonemarkisalreadystoredinrealtime  
according to the operations described in "Basic Recording and Playback".  
Viewing the mark list  
Editing a mark position  
You can edit the current position of a mark in the  
mark map.  
You can view the marks stored.  
While the recorder is stopped,press the [SCENE SEQ./  
1
While the recorder is stopped,press the [SCENE SEQ./  
MAP] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
The Mark map screen appears.  
1
MAP] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
Themarkpositionsareshownbytimeorbar/beat/clock  
values depending on the time base (In the following  
screen example, the time base is set to "Bar/Beat/Clk").  
Use the [JOG] dial or [CURSOR  
the desired mark,and then press the [TIME BASE SEL/  
/
] keys to highlight  
2
F2] key.  
Use the [JOG] dial or [CURSOR  
the marks stored.  
In the Mark map screen, you can not only view all the  
marks but also perform various operations (such as  
editing a mark position, entering a mark title, locating  
a mark, deleting a mark and adding a mark) described  
later.  
/
] keys to scroll  
2
The display shows the screen for editing the chosen  
mark.  
Blinking  
<Hint>  
When the Mark map screen is shown, you can switch  
the screen to display the position (by time or bar/  
beat/clock) or title of each mark by pressing the  
[TIME BASE SEL] key.  
Use the [CURSOR / ] keys to highlight (and flashes)  
the field you want to edit, and then use the [JOG] dial  
3
to select the desired value.  
When the time base is set to "ABS" or "MTC", you can  
edit fields for minute, second, frame and subframe.  
When the time base is set to "Bar/Beat/Clk", you can  
edit fields for bar, beat and clock, as shown below.]  
After viewing the list, press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The display returns to the Normal screen.  
3
Aftereditingtime(orbar/beat/clock),pressthe[ENTER/  
YES] key.  
The edited value is stored to the mark and the display  
returns to the Mark map screen.  
4
5
Press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The display returns to the Normal screen.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Enter a mark title  
Adding a mark  
You can enter or edit a title for each mark.  
You can add a mark to the mark map.  
While the recorder is stopped,press the [SCENE SEQ./  
1
While the recorder is stopped,press the [SCENE SEQ./  
1
MAP] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
MAP] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
The Mark map screen appears.  
The Mark map screen appears.  
Use the [JOG] dial or [CURSOR  
light the desired mark, and then press the [TIME BASE  
/
] keys to high-  
2
Use the [JOG] dial or [CURSOR  
light "New Mark", and then press the [TIME BASE SEL/  
F2] key.  
/
] keys to high-  
SEL/F2] key.  
2
The display shows the screen for editing the chosen  
mark.  
You can find "[New Mark]" at the bottom of the mark map.  
Flashing  
Press the [CURSOR / ] keys repeatedly to highlight  
(and flashes) the leftmost point of the title field.  
3
Flashing  
Highlight (and flashes) this point.  
On the screen for editing the mark, "001" (Bar number  
field) is flashing, showing that it can be edited.  
The mark name is tentatively set to "Mark", while no  
scene is assigned (indicated by "Non").  
Use the [CURSOR / ] keys to move the highlighted  
point among the title field, and use the [JOG] dial to  
select the desired character.  
You can use up to 14 characters for each title but be-  
cause of the screen size, characters displayed at once  
are limited. You can select a character from among the  
following.  
4
Use the [CURSOR / ] keys to highlight (and flashes)  
the field you want to edit among BAR, BEAT and CLK,  
3
and then use the [JOG] dial to select the desired value.  
When setting the time base to ABS or MTC, you can set  
the position in the similar way.  
Aftersettingthemarkposition, pressthe[ENTER/YES]  
key.  
The new mark is added to the mark map and the dis-  
play returns to the Mark map screen.  
4
5
Hint  
When selecting a character, rotating the [JOG] dial  
while holding down the [SHIFT] key jumps among  
characters surrounded with the box above.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The display returns to the Normal screen.  
After entering/editing the title, press the [ENTER/YES]  
key.  
The entered/edited title is stored to the mark.  
<Hint>  
5
6
When adding a new mark, you can also enter a mark title  
or assign a scene for the scene sequence function.  
See "Enter a mark title" above and "Scene Memory" in "Mixer  
Functions" for details about operations.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The display returns to the Normal screen.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recorder Functions  
Deleting a mark  
Locating a mark  
You can delete an unnecessary mark.  
You can directly locate a mark.  
While the recorder is stopped,press the [SCENE SEQ./  
1
While the recorder is stopped,press the [SCENE SEQ./  
1
MAP] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
MAP] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
The Mark map screen appears.  
The Mark map screen appears.  
Use the [JOG] dial or [CURSOR  
light the mark you want to delete, and then press the  
[UNDO/REDO/F3] key while holding down the [SHIFT]  
key.  
"Delete!" is shown and "Sure?" flashes.  
To cancel the delete operation, press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
/
] keys to high-  
2
Use the [JOG] dial or [CURSOR  
light the mark you want to locate, and then press the  
[SETUP/F1] key while holding down the [SHIFT] key.  
The recorder locates to the selected mark, and the dis-  
play returns to the Normal screen.  
/
] keys to high-  
2
<Hint>  
If you press the [SETUP/F1] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key after editing a mark position (see "Editing a  
mark position"), you can locate the new mark position.  
Flashing  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while holding down the  
[RECORD] key.  
The chosen mark is deleted and the mark map is sorted,  
resulting marks following the deleted mark in the mark  
map list move up.  
For example, if you delete Mark 03, the current Mark  
04, 05,... will replace Mark 03, 04,.... respectively.  
3
4
Press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The display returns to the Normal screen.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Advanced Operations  
This chapter describes advanced or useful functions of the VF80.  
Metronome function  
The VF80 provides the internal tempo map, in which you can set the time signature (e.g. 4/4, 3/4) and tempo  
(between 30 and 250).  
It also can output the metronome sound (click) according to the tempo map, allowing you to record materials  
at the specific tempo without the need of an external metronome or rhythm machine.  
The metronome sound can be output from Track 6 of the VF80 when you set "Click?" in the Setup menu to "On."  
<Note>  
When Track 6 is set to output the metronome sound (i.e. when you set "Click?" menu in the Setup menu to "On"),  
you cannot record audio on Track 6 or playback audio recorded on Track 6.  
When you have finished using the metronome function, we recommend setting "Click?" menu in the Setup mode  
to "Off" so that you can use Track 6 for recording and playback.  
Setting the tempo map  
Setting the metronome output  
Youcansetwhetheroutputtingthemetronomesound  
or not by "Click?" menu in the Setup mode.  
To output the metronome sound (click), the tempo  
map must be set.  
To set the tempo map, use "Signature Set" and "Tempo  
Set" menus in the Setup mode.  
Initially, the time signature is set to "4/4" while the  
tempo is set to "120."  
Usethe[JOG]dialtoselectthe"Click?"menu,andthen  
1
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The initial setting is "Off."  
To change the initial settings, operate the following.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select "On", and then press the  
2
While theVF80 is stopped, press the [SETUP] key to  
1
[ENTER/YES] key.  
enter the Setup mode.  
Now the metronome sound will be output from Track  
6.  
The screen for selecting a menu in the Setup mode ap-  
pears.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key repeatedly until exiting the  
3
Use the [JOG] dial to select the "Signature Set" menu,  
2
Setup mode.  
and then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The screen for setting the time signature appears.  
Set the desired time signature according to the proce-  
duredescribedin"Settingthetimesignature"onpage 122.  
Setting the time base to bar/beat  
After setting the time signature, press the [EXIT/NO]  
3
Press the [TIME BASE SEL] key to set the time base to  
1
key to return to the screen for selecting a menu in the  
Setup mode.  
"Bar/Beat."  
When the time base is set to "Bar/Beat", you can moni-  
tor the current position by Bar/Beat according to the  
tempo map you set.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the "Tempo Set" menu,and  
4
then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The screen for setting the tempo appears.  
Set the desired tempo according to the procedure de-  
scribed in "Setting the tempo" on page 124.  
Monitoring the metronome sound  
Press the [PLAY] key to start playback of theVF80.  
1
After setting the tempo, press the [EXIT/NO] key to  
5
ThelevelmeterforTrack6showsthemetronomesound  
level.  
return to the screen for selecting a menu in the Setup  
mode.  
Set the Master and Track 6 faders to the "0" position,  
and raise the [PHONES] knob to monitor the metronome  
sound via the headphones.  
Go on to set the metronome output described below.  
You can now record a material while listening to the  
metronome sound as a guide.  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Track bounce (Ping-pong recording)  
When the number of empty tracks is short in the recording process, you can solve the problem by transferring  
audio on the multiple already-recorded tracks to a different track or tracks.  
This operation is called "Track bounce" or "Ping-pong recording". With the VF80, you can do this operation simply  
by using the [BOUNCE] key.  
When the Bounce mode is active, Tracks 7/8 are automatically armed and the materials recorded on Tracks 1  
through 6 are ready to be bounced to Tracks 7/8.  
In the following description for track bouncing operation, we assume that mono materials are recorded on Tracks  
1 through 4, while a stereo material is recorded on Tracks 5 and 6.  
<Note>  
On/off of bounce mode  
If the peak indicator lights up, the recorded sound  
will be distorted. Adjust the playback level of each  
track appropriately.  
Press the [BOUNCE] key.  
1
Each press of the key alternates "On" and "Off."  
When set to "On", the key is illuminated, while the  
Bounce screen appears where "Remain" is displayed.  
You can see the playback levels on Tracks 1 through 6,  
input levels on Track 7/8 and output levels of the Ste-  
reo busses (L and R) via the meters on the screen.  
By raising the [PHONES] knob, you can monitor the  
sound.  
Tracks 7/8 are automatically armed and the corre-  
sponding[TRACKSTATUS/TRACKSEL] keyflashesinred.  
When the Bounce mode is active, you cannot arm the  
other tracks (1 through 6).  
After adjusting the levels, stop the recorder and then  
locate the beginning position of track bouncing.  
4
Setting pan positions  
Performing the track bounce  
Press the [PAN] key to set the pan position for each  
1
2
track.  
Press the [PLAY] key while holding down the  
[RECORD] key to start track bouncing.  
The recorder starts recording of mixed audio from  
Tracks 1 through 6 to Tracks 7/8.  
1
2
Set the pan positions at the desired points for Tracks 1  
through 4, fully left for Track 5 and fully right for Track  
6. See "Mixer Functions" for details about the pan set-  
ting.  
After finishing the track bounce, press the [STOP] key  
to stop the recorder.  
NowyoucanuseTracks 1 through 6 torecordnew  
materials.  
After setting all pan positions,press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The balance mode screen appears.  
Setting level of each track  
<Notes>  
• You can also apply EQ and/or effects to audio signals  
on Tracks 1 through 6 to be bounce to Track 7/8.  
See "Mixer Function" for details about how to apply EQ  
and effects.  
Set the [MASTER] fader to the "0" position.  
1
2
Press the [RECORD] key only.  
The[RECORD] keystartsflashing,whileTracks7/8enter  
the input monitor mode.  
• When the Bounce mode is active, you can use any of  
effect types L01 through L38. Note that, if you enter  
the Bounce mode when any of insert effect types is  
selected, “L01: Norm HALL” will be automatically  
selected.  
Press the [PLAY] key to start playback and adjust play-  
back levels ofTracks 1 through 6 using the track fad-  
ers.  
3
Be careful not to light up the peak indicator when ad-  
justing the playback level of each track.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Training mode  
The VF80 provides the training mode which allows you to practice your instrument while playing back only Tracks  
7/8. In the training mode, you can slow down the playback speed or altering the pitch, making it easy to play  
along with your favorite musicians or transcribing ad-lib phrases.  
You can also cancel the vocal or lead guitar solo which is positioned in the center, allowing you to replace it with  
your vocal or guitar (like a karaoke).  
The following description shows how to play the guitar along with audio recorded on Tracks 7/8.  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
PHES  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
MUTE  
PLAY  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
<Hint>  
On/Off of training mode  
Because only Tracks 7/8 can be played back in the Train-  
ing mode, you have to record a song used for your prac-  
tice in advance.  
If you are going to use a song recorded on other tracks,  
it will be a good idea to use the track exchange function  
to move the song to Tracks 7/8.  
Press the [TRAINING] key.  
1
Each press of the key alternates "On" and "Off."  
When set to "On", the [TRAINING] key is illuminated,  
while the display shows the training mode screen.  
Also, when you want to use an external source on CD,  
MD, etc., record it onto Tracks 7/8 digitally using the  
technique described later in "Digital Recording."  
<Caution>  
When copying a copyright material from CD, MD, etc.,  
do not use the copy for any purpose except your prac-  
tice or enjoyment. Any unauthorized use of the copy  
for commercial purpose will constitute infringement  
of such copyright and will render the infringer liable  
to an action at law.  
On the training mode screen, you can set the follow-  
ing. You can use the [CURSOR  
/
] key to select (high-  
light) the item to be set.  
<Note>  
When the training mode is active, you cannot make any  
recording, as well as playback Tracks 1 through 6.  
1. Playback speed  
2. Playback pitch  
3. On/Off of the center cancel function  
4. Setting of the cancel position  
5. Low boost setting (for emphasizing the bass  
sound)  
Connecting the instrument and headphones  
Set the [MASTER] fader to the "" position.  
1
2
<Note>  
Connect the instrument and headphones as shown in  
the illustration above.  
You can set the playback speed only while the VF80  
is stopped. The other items can be set both while  
stopped and during playback.  
You may connect the instrument either [INPUT A] or  
[INPUT B].  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Slowing down the playback speed  
Setting the cancel position  
You can change the playback speed only while the  
recorder is stopped.  
Using the [CURSOR ] key to highlight the "Cancel  
Pos" field, and then use the [JOG] dial to set the de-  
1
sired value.  
When "Norm" in the "Play Speed" field is highlighted,  
1
You can select the cancel position from "-99" via "0" to  
"+99" in one step increments.  
Try to find the best position where the sound to be  
cancel gets lowest.  
use the [JOG] dial to select "Half."  
The playback speed is set to half the normal speed and  
the pitch automatically raises one octave.  
To change only the pitch, see the next section.  
To return to the normal speed, use the [JOG] dial to  
2
select "Norm."  
The playback speed returns to the normal speed.  
Boosting the bass sound  
Using the [CURSOR ] key to highlight the "Lo Boost"  
field, and then use the [JOG] dial to set the desired  
value.  
You can select the low boost level from "0" to "10" in one  
step increments.  
1
Changing the pitch  
The following items can be set both while stopped and  
during playback.  
Usingthe[CURSOR ]keytohighlightthe"PlayPitch"  
1
field, and then use the [JOG] dial to select the desired  
pitch.  
You can set the pitch within the range of +/- one octave.  
Playing along with the playback sound  
Set the [MASTER] fader to the "0" position.  
1
2
Canceling the center-positioned sound  
Press the [PLAY] key to starts playback of theVF80 and  
raise theTrack 7/8 fader gradually.  
You can see the level is going up via the stereo output  
level meters (L and R) on the screen.  
Rotate the [PHONES] knob to adjust the headphones  
level.  
Using the [CURSOR ] key to highlight the "Vo. Can-  
1
cel" field, and then use the [JOG] dial to select "ON".  
You can cancel the center-positioned sound such as a  
lead vocal.  
Depending on audio sources, you may not perfectly  
cancel the sound you want to remove because it is not  
exactly center-positioned. In such a case, perform the  
next operation.  
Play the guitar along with the playback sound ofTracks  
7/8, while adjusting the [TRIM] knob to the appropri-  
ate position where the [PEAK] indicator for the input  
3
you connect the guitar does not light.  
You can hear both the playback sound of Tracks 7/8  
and your guitar together from the headphones.  
If you move down the Tracks 7/8 fader, you can only  
hear your guitar.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Mastering mode  
You can use Tracks 7/8 as the mastering tracks.  
After performing the track bouncing to mix down track signals to Tracks 7/8, you can record the audio signals  
on Tracks 7/8 to an external (analog or digital) master recorder with applying EQ, reverb and compressor for  
mastering (see the illustration below).  
You can perform the above operation in the mastering mode, which can be selected by the [MASTERING] key.  
When the mastering mode is active, only Tracks 7/8 can be played back, while the dedicated sound processing  
for mastering is available. In the following description, we assume that the stereo mix signals are recorded on  
Tracks 7/8.  
STEREO OUT L, R  
Digital master recorder  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF  
OUTPUT  
/
DATA  
INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
INPUT  
S/P DIF OUTPUT  
Analog master recorder  
You can select a desired preset entry  
from10entriesstoredintheeffectlibrary.  
See "Mastering library details" on the  
next page.  
Selecting a program to be played back  
Mastering library  
If there is more than one program in the VF80, select  
the desired program to be played back.  
See "Selecting a program" for the operation.  
Adjusts the EQ gain for the high fre-  
quency range within a +/- 18 dB range.  
Freq. and Q: fixed  
High Gain  
On/off of mastering mode  
Adjusts the EQ gain for the middle fre-  
quency range within a +/- 18 dB range.  
Freq. and Q: fixed  
Mid Gain  
EQ  
Press the [MASTERING] key.  
1
Each press of the [MASTERING] key alternates ON and  
OFF of the mastering mode.  
Adjusts the EQ gain for the low fre-  
quency range within a +/- 18 dB range.  
Freq. and Q: fixed  
When setting to ON, the[MASTERING] key is illuminated  
and the following screen is displayed, while the [TRACK  
STATUS/TRACK SEL] key of Track 7/8 and the [STATUS/  
SEL] key for the master are illuminated in green.  
Low Gain  
Rev Level  
Adjusts the amount of reverb sound be-  
tween 0 and 99.  
Ambience  
RevTime  
Pre Delay  
Fixed(SeeMasteringlibrarydetailson  
the next page.  
Adjusts the threshold of the compres-  
sor between -50 dB and 0 dB in 1 dB  
steps.  
Threshold  
Ratio  
Selects the compressor ratio from the  
following options.  
:1, 20:1, 10:1, 8:1, 6:1, 5:1, 4:1, 3.5:1,  
3:1, 2.5:1, 2:1, 1,7:1, 1.5:1, 1.3:1, 1.1:1,  
1:1  
The screen example above shows the upper part of the  
mastering setting. Pressing the [CURSOR ] key scrolls  
down the setting items. To scroll up, press the [CUR-  
SOR ] key.  
Compressor  
Adjusts the compressor gain between  
0 dB and +18 dB.  
Gain  
Fixed (SeeMastering library detailson  
the next page.  
Atack  
Selects ON or OFF of the copy protec-  
tion for the S/P DIF output signal.  
When set to ON, the flag for limiting a  
digital copy to one generation is set in  
the S/P DIF digital output signal.  
Copy Protect  
The table below shows the mastering setting items.  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
After setting the recording level,return theVF80 to the  
beginning of the program.  
2
3
<Hint>  
When selecting a desired preset entry from the Master-  
ing library, the initial parameter values of the entry are  
shown on the screen.  
See "Mastering library details" on the next page for the  
detailed information.  
Start recording of the master recorder and then start  
playback of theVF80.  
The stereo output (L and R) signals are recorded onto  
the master recorder.  
Setting the mastering parameters  
4
After finishing recording, stop the both machines.  
Set the [MASTER] fader at the "0" position.  
1
2
<Hint>  
Start playback and move up theTrack 7/8 fader gradu-  
ally.  
You can monitor the playback sound of Tracks 7/8 by  
rotating the [PHONES] knob clockwise.  
In the mastering mode, you cannot monitor the play-  
back sound of other tracks even if you move up the  
faders.  
When you record VF80 audio onto a digital master  
recorder via the S/P DIF digital signal, if the copy  
protection ("Cp Protect") is set to "ON", you can limit  
the digital copy from the master to another recorder.  
If you do not want to make digital copies freely from  
the master, set the copy protection to "ON."  
Use the [CURSOR / ] key to highlight the parameter  
value to be edited, and use the [JOG] dial to select the  
3
desired value.  
You can monitor the tailored sound of Tracks 7/8 in  
realtime.  
Mastering library details  
The mastering library provides 10 preset entries  
which can only be used in the mastering mode.  
When applying mastering processing to the sound,  
you can use a desired preset as a starting point of your  
setting.  
The following table shows the initial settings of EQ,  
reverb and compressor parameters, as well as the  
major usage for each preset.  
<Hint>  
When any parameter value is changed from the  
initial setting, "E" appears on the right of the preset  
entry name (as shown below), showing that the cur-  
rent setting is different from the initial setting.  
<Comment>  
Basic mastering set-  
tings.  
L0: FLAT  
Gain  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
0
0
Can be used for a wide  
range of music genre.  
L-S  
1
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
400Hz  
1kHz  
On/off of the mastering processing  
0
H-S  
4kHz  
To switch on or off the mastering processing, use the  
[CURSOR / ] key to highlight the ON/OFF icon as  
Ambience  
0 (Rev Level)  
1
Rev Time=1.0s / Pre Dly=0ms : fixed  
shown below, and use the [JOG] dial to select "ON" or  
"OFF".  
When "ON" is selected, the tailored sound is output.  
When "OFF" is selected, the original sound is output.  
Comp THSHD  
-25  
4 : 1  
+10  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
Atack Time = 8ms : fixed  
<Comment>  
Makes a dry sound  
wet.  
L1:Wet Mix  
Gain  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
0
0
L-S  
1.0  
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
400Hz  
1kHz  
Recording onto the master recorder  
+4.0  
H-S  
8kHz  
Stand by the master recorder for recording, and start  
playback of theVF80.  
Ambience  
75 (Rev Level)  
1
Rev Time=0.5s / Pre Dly=0ms : fixed  
You have to adjust the recording level now.  
When the recording signal is digitally transferred from  
theVF80totherecorder, becauseadigitalrecorderusu-  
ally does not provide the function for controlling the  
digital input level, you must adjust the recording level  
by controlling the stereo output level of the VF80 us-  
ing the [MASTER] fader.  
Comp THSHD  
-30  
3 : 1  
+10  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
Atack Time = 5ms : fixed  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
<Comment>  
Powerful sound.  
<Comment>  
Makes a dark sound  
bright.  
L6: Hard  
L2: Light Mix  
Gain  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
Gain  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
0
0
0
L-S  
1
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
400Hz  
1kHz  
4kHz  
0
0
L-S  
1.0  
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
400Hz  
1kHz  
H-S  
+4.0  
H-S  
8kHz  
Ambience  
0 (Rev Level)  
Ambience  
0 (Rev Level)  
Rev Time=1.0s / Pre Dly=0ms : fixed  
Rev Time=1.0s / Pre Dly=0ms : fixed  
Comp THSHD  
-36  
Comp THSHD  
-42  
3 : 1  
+18  
8 : 1  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
+18  
Atack Time = 5ms : fixed  
Atack Time = 10ms : fixed  
<Comment>  
Soulful and energetic  
sound of 70s'.  
<Comment>  
L7: 70s  
L3: Live Mix  
Makes a sound like  
recorded in a small  
live house.  
Gain  
Gain  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
0
0
-6  
0
L-S  
1.0  
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
L-S  
1
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
400Hz  
1kHz  
400Hz  
1kHz  
6kHz  
H-S  
LPF-ON  
LPF  
-18  
8kHz  
Ambience  
99 (Rev Level)  
Ambience  
0 (Rev Level)  
Rev Time=0.1s / Pre Dly=30ms : fixed  
Rev Time=1.0s / Pre Dly=0ms : fixed  
Comp THSHD  
-20  
1.5 : 1  
+8  
Comp THSHD  
-10  
5 : 1  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
+2  
Atack Time = 5ms : fixed  
Atack Time = 5ms : fixed  
<Comment>  
Makes a sound like  
recorded in a concert  
hall.  
<Comment>  
Suitable for typical  
pop music with vocal.  
L8: Hall  
L4: Pop Mix  
Gain  
Gain  
-3  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
+4  
-4  
-8  
L-S  
1
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
400Hz  
500Hz  
6kHz  
L-S  
2.0  
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
400Hz  
500Hz  
-3  
H-S  
H-S  
+2  
4kHz  
Ambience  
80 (Rev Level)  
Ambience  
80 (Rev Level)  
Rev Time=3.0s / Pre Dly=100ms : fixed  
Rev Time=0.7s / Pre Dly=0ms : fixed  
-36  
3.5 : 1  
+18  
Comp THSHD  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
-25  
1.5 : 1  
+5  
Comp THSHD  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
Atack Time = 10ms : fixed  
Atack Time = 8ms : fixed  
<Comment>  
<Comment>  
Narrow range sound  
by limiting the fre-  
quency range drasti-  
cally.  
L5: Dance  
L9: LO_Fi  
Suitable for a dancing  
floor.A speedy sound  
which makes an audi-  
ence excite.  
Gain  
+10  
-18  
Gain  
-18  
Freq. (fixed) Q (fixed)  
Freq. (fixed)  
400Hz  
2kHz  
Q (fixed)  
L-S  
3.5  
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
400Hz  
550Hz  
L-S  
1
EQ Lo  
EQ Mid  
EQ Hi  
+15  
+15  
3.5  
10kHz  
LPF-ON  
LPF  
2kHz  
Ambience  
0 (Rev Level)  
Ambience  
0 (Rev Level)  
Rev Time=1.0s / Pre Dly=0ms : fixed  
Rev Time=1.0s / Pre Dly=0ms : fixed  
Comp THSHD  
-30  
Comp THSHD  
-25  
5 : 1  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
: 1  
Comp Ratio  
Comp Gain  
+14  
+5  
Atack Time = 5ms : fixed  
Atack Time = 5ms : fixed  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Internal Mastering Function  
The internal mastering function is an expansion of the mastering function described earlier.  
It allows you to record a mixed-down material on tracks 7 and 8 to the current drive on the VF80  
while applying a mastering effect.  
Therefore, unlike the mastering function, this function allows you to make high-quality mastering  
inside the VF80, without the need of an external master recorder.  
In addition, by installing the optional CD-RW drive (Model CD-1A), you can create original audio  
CDs from the materials mixed down internally using the internal mastering function. See "Making an  
Audio CD" on page 115 in "Save/load of song data" for details.  
<Newly added internal mastering function>  
<Conventional mastering mode>  
Analog Master Recorder  
Digital Master Recorder  
Mastering Effect  
New Program  
ST OUT  
Tracks 1 & 2  
Tracks 7 & 8  
S/P DIF OUT  
L
R
VF80  
Mastering Effect  
<Figure-2>  
The internal mastering function allows you  
to carry out all operations using the VF80  
only.  
Tracks 7 & 8  
<Figure-1>  
VF80  
<Please read this first before carrying out operations in the internal mastering mode!>  
After executing internal mastering, a new program which saves a mastering material is automatically  
created on the current drive, whose program number is set to one greater than the current greatest  
program number.  
For example, if there are 8 programs (P01 through 08) on the current drive, after mastering a desired  
program data using the internal mastering function, a new program (P09) is automatically created and  
the mastering signals produced by the mastering function are recorded on tracks 1 and 2 of P09.  
Note that if the VF80 is under either of the following conditions, you cannot carry out internal mastering.  
1. There are 99 programs already existed on the current drive even though there is enough  
recording space.  
If you try to carry out internal mastering, "Can't New PGM!" is shown and the operation is ignored.  
To carry out internal mastering, delete an unnecessary program.  
2. There is not enough remaining space even though there are less than 99 programs on the current  
drive.  
If you try to carry out internal mastering, "OverTime!" is shown and the operation is ignored.  
To carry out internal mastering, erase unnecessary song data or delete an unnecessary program.  
See "Deleting a program" on page 62 and "Erasing track data" on page 66 in this manual.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Rehearsing internal mastering  
Before performing the internal mastering, you can rehearse it as many times as you like, while  
adjusting the track 7/8 level and sound effects.  
In the following description, we assumes that a bounced material is recorded on tracks 7/8 of the  
playback program. Headphones for monitoring are connected to the [PHONES] jack.  
[PHONES] [TRACK EDIT]  
[MASTERING]  
[ENTER/YES]  
5
1
3
1
INPUT  
BAL  
A
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PHONES  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
SCENE SCENE SEQ.  
TRACK  
EDIT  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
1[JOG]  
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
1[SHIFT]  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
EDIT  
7[STOP] + [REWIND]  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
4[PLAY]  
2
5
[MASTER FADER]  
[7/8 FADER]  
6[STOP]  
Press the [PLAY] key to start playback from the  
4
Select the desired program for mastering.  
To select the desired program, while stopped, press  
the [TRACK EDIT/PGM] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key, and select the program using the [JOG]  
dial, then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
1
beginning of the selected program.  
The VF80 starts playback, while the display keeps  
showing the screen for adjusting the mastering effects.  
Tracks 1 and 2 are internally set to "input monitor",  
allowing you to check over-level via the peak LED  
indicators.  
You can monitor the mastering sound through  
headphones by raising the track 7/8 fader and/or  
[PHONES] level control. The mastering levels are  
shown on the level meters at the right on the screen.  
Set the [MASTER] fader to the "0" position.  
2
3
Press the [MASTERING] key.  
The VF80 enters the mastering mode and the display  
shows the mastering screen in which you can adjust  
the mastering effects.  
The [MASTERING] key lights up in red, while the [TRACK  
STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys of tracks 7/8 and the master  
channel light up in green.  
During playback, adjust track 7/8 levels using  
the 7/8 fader, as well as EQ and effect settings if  
5
necessary.  
Set the levels properly so that the PEAK LED indica-  
tors do not flash or light frequently.  
Note that levels may increase by changing EQ or  
compressor parameters. When controlling the sound  
characters and level, you should not only monitor the  
level meters and listen to the sound, but also monitor  
the PEAK LED indicators.  
To adjusting the mastering effect parameters on the  
mastering screen, use the [CURSOR] (  
/
) keys to  
select a parameter and the [JOG] dial to change the  
<screen for adjusting the mastering effects>  
parameter value.  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Press the [REWIND] key while holding down the  
[STOP] key to locate the beginning of the pro-  
gram.  
7
<Hint>  
On the mastering screen, you can tailor the sound  
by adjusting EQ settings (HI, MID and LOW), as well  
as the ambiance and compressor.  
The VF80 locates the beginning of the program im-  
mediately and "00m 00s" is shown at the top right of  
the screen. Keep showing the same mastering screen  
after stopping the VF80 and locating the beginning of  
the program.  
To repeat the rehearsal, perform steps 4 and 5 re-  
peatedly after making the VF80 locate the beginning  
of the program. After completing the rehearsal satis-  
factorily, make sure to locate the beginning of the  
program.  
See page 76 for details about the mastering effects.  
<Note>  
In the internal mastering function, the "CpProtect"  
(Copy Protect) setting, which is one of the master-  
ing effect items, does not affect the internally record  
material. The copy protect setting affects materials  
recorded on a CD-RW/CD-R disc, described later.  
See "Making an audio CD" on page 115.  
<Note>  
After completing the rehearsal, be careful not to move  
the track 7/8 and master faders and change the mas-  
tering effect parameters.  
If you wish to do another job after the rehearsal, you  
should save the settings (fader positions and param-  
eter settings) to a scene memory. See page 52 in the  
owner's manual for details about the “scene memory”  
function.  
After completing all the adjustments, press the  
[STOP] key to stop the VF80.  
6
Performing internal mastering  
Please read the following notes carefully before performing internal mastering.  
Press the [PLAY] key while holding down the  
[RECORD] key. (You cannot perform the auto  
punch- in function.)  
When mastering starts, a new program is automati-  
cally created and the material is recorded onto track  
1 and 2 of the program. The ABS time at which mas-  
tering starts is registered with the "Start point" of the  
new program.  
1
<Note:There is no need for selecting recording tracks.>  
In the internal mastering function, unlike the normal  
recording, you do not have to select recording tracks.  
When recording a take in the internal mastering func-  
tion according to the following procedure, the VF80 au-  
tomatically arms Tracks 1 and 2.  
Therefore, the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys for tracks  
1 and 2 never light up in red during recording.  
When completing mastering, press the [STOP]  
key to stop.  
2
<Note>  
"Please wait" appears on the display for a few seconds,  
and the internal mastering mode quits, while the VF80  
locates the beginning (ABS 0) of the newly created  
program. The ABS time at which you press the [STOP]  
key is registered with the "End point" of the new pro-  
gram.  
The following screen example shows that a title named  
"Song Data-1" is mastered onto a new program named  
"P09". As shown in the example below, "Mst<-" is pre-  
fixed to a mastered program title, so that you can dis-  
tinguish mastered programs from other programs.  
The screen can show up to the first 12 characters of a  
title name.  
Internal mastering cannot be performed if rec-protected.  
If the "Rec Protected" setting of the setup mode is set to  
"ON", you cannot perform internal mastering.  
If you try to perform it, a warning message ("Protected!")  
appears on the display. If this message appears, set the  
"Rec Protected" setting to "OFF" before performing in-  
ternal mastering.  
See page 129 in the owner's manual for details about  
the setup mode.  
<Note:You cannot undo an internal mastering take.>  
You cannot undo an internal mastering take.  
If you are not satisfied with the result, try again from  
the beginning.  
If you do not need a previously recorded program, de-  
lete the program according to the procedure described  
in "Deleting a Program" of the owner's manual.  
A title example recorded using the internal mastering mode.  
<Note:The vari-pitch setting is not effective.>  
When recording a take in the internal mastering func-  
tion, the vari-pitch setting is not effective and the take  
is always recorded at the normal speed.  
Playback the newly created program (P09, in the  
3
example above) to check the result.  
You can adjust the playback levels of mastered tracks  
using track faders 1 and 2.  
Read the following "Hint" carefully before making an  
original audio CD from mastered materials.  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
<About Start and End points>  
As described earlier, the starting and ending times of internal mastering are automatically  
registered as "Start point" and "End point" respectively, which can be used for track editing  
(copy, move and erase) for the newly created program (see the illustrations below).  
This function is very convenient for making an audio CD from mastered materials, because  
data between "Start point" and "End point" is automatically transferred to a CD-RW/CD-R disc.  
Note that you cannot make an audio CD using the VF80 save function (described later) without  
setting these two points.  
Data transferred to a CD-RW/CD-R disc  
Start point  
(automatically registered)  
End point  
(automatically registered)  
New program (Tracks 1 & 2)  
Internal mastering  
Original program (Tracks 7 & 8)  
Start point of internal mastering  
End point of internal mastering  
The "Start point" and "End point" which have been automatically set can be checked after com-  
pleting mastering by the following procedure.  
Press the [TRACK EDIT/PGM] key while the  
VF80 is stopped.  
1
<Note>  
You can edit the "Start point" and "End point" be-  
fore creating an audio CD, allowing adjustment  
of intervals between songs.  
The display shows the screen for track editing, where  
"Copy Paste" flashes.  
We recommend to set the "Start point" and "End  
point" of the new program created by the internal  
mastering to desired times before creating an  
audio CD.  
Flashing  
After checking the "Start" and "End" points,  
press the [EXIT/NO] key to quit the track edit  
mode.  
The display returns to the previous screen before  
performing step 1.  
4
Press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting an origi-  
nal and destination tracks for copy/paste.  
2
See page 115 about how to make an audio CD from  
mastered materials.  
<Hint>  
When recording more than one song continuously  
to a CD-RW/CD-R disc, the VF80 automatically  
record an approximately 2-second silence after each  
END point.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key again.  
The display shows the screen for selecting edit  
points, in which you can check "Start" and "End"  
points that hold the beginning and end points of  
the recording respectively (pointed by arrows be-  
low).  
3
Start point  
End point  
Start point  
Start point  
End point  
End point  
3
1
2
Silence (about 2 seconds)  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Using the insert effect  
Unlike the loop effect described earlier in "Mixer Functions", the insert effect is applied when  
rerecording any recorded track among tracks 1 through 6.  
This rerecording mode in which the insert effect is applied is called "REC EFFECT" mode.  
Six distortion/simulation type effects are available for the insert effect. You can distort a guitar,  
bass, drums or vocal, as well as simulate a famous guitar amplifier or microphone character.  
<How to use the loop effect>  
<How to use the insert effect>  
Track 1  
Track 2  
Track 3  
Track 4  
Track 5  
Track 6  
Track 7  
Track 8  
Track 1  
Track 2  
ASP  
Track 3  
Track 4  
Track 5  
Track 6  
Track 7  
Track 8  
ASP  
Effect  
ASP  
Effect  
Track 1  
Effect  
Master Recorder  
<Track bounce>  
<Mixdown>  
<Effect types available for the insert effect>  
There are six effect types below available for the insert effect, in addition to 38 types for the loop effect as  
described earlier in "Mixer Functions".  
See page xx for details about parameters for each effect type.  
“L39: Gtr Dist (guitar distortion)”  
“L42:Voice Dist (voice distortion)”  
“L43: Gtr Amp Sim (guitar amp simulator)”  
“L40: Bass Dist (bass distortion)”  
“L41: Drum Dist (drum distortion)”  
“L44: Mic Sim (microphone simulator)”  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
The following explains how to record a guitar solo to track 1 and rerecord it while applying the  
guitar distortion. Before executing recording, you can check the guitar sound with the distortion  
effect while rehearsing the effect parameter settings until you satisfy with the sound.  
We assume that the guitar is connected to the [INPUT A] connector and the VF80 locates to the  
beginning of the program (ABS 0).  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
PHES  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK MASTER  
CURSOR  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
Use the [JOG] dial to select "L39: Gtr Dist" and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
6
Rehearsal  
You can check the guitar sound with an effect be-  
fore recording.  
"L39:Gtr Dist" should be selected for the guitar dis-  
tortion.  
"Insert Effect Selected!" is momentarily shown on the  
display, followed by the parameter setting screen for  
"L39: Gtr Dist".  
Meanwhile, the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys for  
tracks 1 through 6 starts flashing, showing that you  
can select a track to which the effect is inserted.  
Press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key for  
1
track 1 to arm track 1.  
Only the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key for track 1  
flashes, while the [CH ON/OFF] key lights.  
Raise the track 1 fader and [MASTER] fader to  
2
the "0" position.  
If these faders are not raised, you cannot monitor the  
sound.  
Press the [RECORD] key.  
Track 1 is switched to "Input monitor".  
3
4
Press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key for  
track 1.  
Only the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key for track 1  
flashes, showing that track 1 is selected.  
7
8
Adjust the gain appropriately using the [TRIM]  
control for [INPUT A] while playing the guitar.  
You can monitor the guitar sound by raising the  
[PHONES] control.  
Adjust parameters while playing the guitar to get  
the desired sound.  
You can select a desired parameter using the [CUR-  
Press the [EFFECT] key repeatedly until the ef-  
5
SOR]  
/
keys and change the value using the [JOG]  
fect type selection screen appears.  
When you press the [EFFECT] key for the first time  
after turning on the power, "L01:Norm HALL" is shown  
as the effect type.  
dial.  
Before editing parameters, you can monitor the sound  
with the default parameter settings.  
The monitor sound changes in realtime when chang-  
ing a parameter.  
See the next page for details about the parameters for  
"L39: Gtr Dist".  
<Caution!>  
Do not raise the headphones volume too loud while  
monitoring the sound, which may damage your ears.  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
<How to edit parameters>  
<Storing parameter settings>  
It will be a good idea to store a favorite pa-  
rameter setting to a scene.  
You can recall a stored setting whenever you  
like. See page 52 for details about the scene  
memory.  
The "L39: Gtr Dist" effect type has 11 parameters as  
shown below. (Note that the screen example below  
shows all parameters for the explanation. Actually,  
you can see 5 parameters at a time while the other  
parameters are hidden.)  
Use the [CURSOR]  
/
keys to select a highlighted  
parameter. Use the [JOG] dial to select the value of  
the highlighted parameter.  
The monitor sound changes in realtime when chang-  
ing a parameter.  
Recording the guitar  
After making desired effect parameter settings in  
rehearsal, record the guitar while monitoring the  
effected sound.  
Note that the dry sound is recorded though you  
monitor the wet sound.  
We assume that track 1 is "Input monitor" (i.e. the  
[RECORD] key and the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL]  
key for track 1 are flashing).  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key to switch to the Normal  
screen.  
1
2
Selects a distortion type.  
Options: Acous, Rythm, OvDrv, Dist, Blues,  
Fuzz, Lead, Metal (Default: Dist)  
1. DistType  
2. Dist Gain  
Press the [PLAY] key while holding down the  
[RECORD] key to start recording and play the  
guitar.  
Adjusts the distortion gain.  
Range: 1 to 15 (The default depends on  
the distortion type selected.)  
The dry sound is recorded to track 1 while the wet  
sound is monitored.  
The screen shows both the recording level of the gui-  
tar and the monitor level.  
Makes the sound warmer when On.  
Options: ON, OFF (default: ON)  
3.Warm  
4. Bass  
Adjusts the low frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 5)  
Adjusts the mid frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 5)  
5. Middle  
Adjusts the high frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 5)  
6.Treble  
Press the [STOP] key to stop recording.  
The [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key for track 1 still  
flashes, while the [RECORD] key turns off.  
3
4
Turns on or off the noise gate.  
Options: OFF, 1 to 99 (default: OFF)  
7. Noise Gate  
Press the [REWIND] key while holding down the  
[STOP] key to locate to the beginning of the pro-  
gram.  
Sets the output level of the distortion.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 80)  
8. Out Level  
Sets the delay time.  
Range: 5 ms to 1200 ms (default: 250 ms)  
9. DelayTime  
<To playback the recorded sound>  
To check the recorded "dry" sound just re-  
corded, press the [EFFECT] key while holding  
down the [SHIFT] key to turn off the effect,  
then press [PLAY] key to start playback.  
If you do not turn off the effect, the "wet"  
playback sound is monitored with the effect  
you set in rehearsal.  
Sets the feedback level of the distortion.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 40)  
10. Feedback  
Sets the delay level.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 0)  
11. Delay Level  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Press the [PLAY] key while holding down the  
[RECORD] key to start recording.  
3
Rerecording with effect  
The final step is to rerecord the recorded "dry" sound  
on track 1 while applying the effect (guitar distor-  
tion) with the setting you made in rehearsal.  
During recording in the “REC EFFECT mode”, the  
[BOUNCE/REC EFF] key is flashing in red.  
Press the [STOP] key to stop recording.  
4
5
Press the [BOUNCE/REC EFF] key.  
Press the [BOUNCE/REC EFF] key while hold-  
ing down the [SHIFT] key.  
1
The unit exits the REC EFFECT mode, and the [BOUNCE/  
REC EFF] key turns off, while the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK  
SEL] key for track 1 lights steadily in green.  
The unit enter the REC EFFECT mode, in which you  
can apply the insert effect. The screen shows some-  
thing like below.  
The [BOUNCE/REC EFF] key and the [TRACK STATUS/  
TRACK SEL] key for track 1 flash.  
Press the [REWIND] key while holding down the  
[STOP] key to locate to the beginning of the pro-  
gram.  
6
7
Press the [EFFECT] key while holding down the  
[SHIFT] key to turn off the effect.  
The [EFFECT] key turns off.  
<Note>  
Before playing back the rerecorded sound, always  
turn off the effect by the above operation.  
If you playback the rerecorded sound while the ef-  
fect is set to ON, you will monitor the "wet" sound  
with applying the effect.  
<Selecting a recording track>  
When entering the REC EFFECT mode, the [TRACK  
STATUS/TRACK SEL] key for track 1 flashes. You can  
select any track to be recorded from among tracks  
1 through 6 by pressing the appropriate [TRACK  
STATUS/TRACK SEL] key.  
Press the [PLAY] key to start playback from the  
beginning of the program.  
You can confirm that the "dry" sound on track 1 is  
replaced with the "wet" sound.  
8
In this example, you are going to record to track 1,  
so you do not have to change the setting.  
Press the [EFFECT] key.  
2
<To cancel recording>  
The effect type selection screen appears, where "L39  
Gtr Dist" is selected. All parameter are set as you did  
during rehearsal.  
If you are not satisfied with the result, press the  
[UNDO/REDO] key to undo the last recording, and  
make recording again. Pressing the [UNDO/REDO]  
key once returns track 1 to the "dry" sound.  
Pressing the [UNDO/REDO] key again returns track 1  
back to the "wet" sound.  
If you like, try recording in the similar manner by select-  
ing the other effect type.  
<Notes for the REC EFFECT mode>  
• In the REC EFFECT mode, you can select an effect type  
only from among L39 through L44.  
If you enter the REC EFFECT mode from the  
condition in which an effect type for the loop effect  
is selected, "L39: Gtr Dist" will be initially selected.  
<Make sure that the effect is set to ON>  
If the effect is set to OFF, press the [EFFECT] key  
while holding down the [SHIFT] key to switch it to  
ON.  
<Check the recording level>  
• In the REC EFFECT mode, if you recall a scene in which  
the loop effect is used, the effect type is not changed.  
Or, when a track the insert effect is applied to is  
selected, if you recall a scene in which a track the  
insert effect is applied to is selected, the track  
selection is not recalled. In such a case, use the [TRACK  
STATUS/TRACK SEL] key to change the selection.  
When applying the insert effect, you can adjust the  
recording level by the "Out Level" parameter.  
Before starting recording, check/adjust the record-  
ing level by following the procedure below. Note  
that the channel fader, [MASTER] fader, EQ and pan  
only affect the monitor sound.  
1. Use the [JOG] dial to highlight the "Out Level"  
parameter.  
• In the REC EFFECT mode, You cannot set "Scene  
Sequence" and "Digital In" to ON. If you enter the  
REC EFFECT mode while one or both of these are set  
to ON, the unit automatically sets it (them) to OFF.  
2. Press the [RECORD] key to monitor the input.  
3. Press the [PLAY] key to start playback from the  
beginning.  
• In the REC EFFECT mode, you cannot playback or  
record tracks 7 and 8 (the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK  
SEL] keys never light up).  
4. While monitoring the playback sound with  
applying the effect, adjust the "Out Level" value  
appropriately using the [JOG] dial so that the  
PEAK indicator does not light frequently.  
• To rerecord a desired part of a track with applying  
the insert effect, it will be a good idea to use the auto  
punch-in/out function. See page 33 for details about  
the auto punch-in/out.  
5. After setting the level, locate to the beginning of  
the program.  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
• Parameters for distortion effects  
(Parameter type: DISTORTION)  
Effect types No.39 through 42 (shown in "Effect type list" on  
page 49) are distortion types.  
Details of each distortion type  
Each distortion type (selectable for each of effect  
types No.39 through 42) can apply the effect as de-  
scribed below.  
Each of these has 11 parameters as shown below.  
• Distortion types for "L39: Gtr Dist"  
The default distortion gain value depends on the  
distortion type selected.  
Default  
Comment  
Name  
Dist Gain  
Acoustic  
You can get an electric-acoustic  
guitar sound  
1
Rhythm  
You can get a slight distortion when  
picking the guitar strongly.  
4
Over Drive You can get a smooth distortion like  
15  
15  
15  
driving a tube amplifier.  
Distortion  
Blues  
Fuzz  
You can get a hard distortion like  
driving a three-stacked amplifier.  
Selects a distortion type.  
You can get a fat overdrive sound.  
Each effect type has following distortion  
type options. (An underlined option is  
the default.)  
You can get a rough sound with a fat  
low frequency range.  
L39: Acous, Rythm, OvDrv, Dist, Blues, Fuzz,  
15  
15  
15  
1. DistType  
Lead, Metal  
L40: Bass1, Bass2, Bass3  
L41: Kick, Snar1, Snar2  
L42: Voic1,Voic2,Voic3  
Lead  
You can get a bright and smooth  
distortion.  
Metal  
You can get a shred sound.  
See the table on the right for details  
about each type.  
Adjusts the distortion gain.  
Range: 1 to 15 (The default depends on  
the distortion type selected. See the table  
on the right.)  
2. Dist Gain  
• Distortion types for "L40: Bass Dist"  
Bass 1  
Bass 2  
Simulates a bass amplifier.  
You can get a sound like recording a  
distorted bass sound through a line.  
Makes the sound warmer when On.  
Options: ON, OFF (default: ON)  
3.Warm  
4. Bass  
Bass 3  
You can get a fat bass sound.  
Adjusts the low frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 5)  
• Distortion types for "L41: Drum Dist"  
Adjusts the mid frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 5)  
5. Middle  
Kick  
You can distort a kick sound  
appropriately.  
Adjusts the high frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 5)  
Snar 1  
Snar 2  
You can distort a snar sound appropriately.  
You can distort a snar sound excessively.  
6.Treble  
Turns on or off the noise gate.  
Options: OFF, 1 to 99 (default: OFF)  
7. Noise Gate  
• Distortion types for "L42:Voice Dist"  
Sets the output level of the distortion.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 80)  
8. Out Level  
Voic 1  
Voic 2  
Voic 3  
You can get a smooth distortion.  
You can get a boomy and bright distortion.  
You can get a bullhorn sound.  
Sets the delay time.  
Range: 5 ms to 1200 ms (default: 250 ms)  
9. DelayTime  
Sets the feedback level of the distortion.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 40)  
10. Feedback  
Sets the delay level.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 0)  
11. Delay Level  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
• Parameters for distortion effects  
(Parameter type: AMP SIMULATION)  
Effect type No.43 (shown in "Effect type list" on page 49) is  
the amp simulation type.  
Details of each amplifier types  
Five guitar amplifier types can be simulated.  
Each amplifier type has its own unique character as  
described below.  
The default distortion gain value depends on the  
amplifier type selected.  
This effect type has 11 parameters as shown below.  
Default  
Comment  
Name  
Amp Gain  
British 800 Amplifier  
Simulates the 800-series British tube  
amplifier, a synonym for "rock".  
The king of the rock sound of the  
80's hard rock and heavy metal.  
Distorted raging sound.  
Brit800  
8
Tremo Rect Amplifier  
Simulates the American combo  
model amplifier, designed to get  
high gain sound for the 90's hard  
rock and heavy metal.  
TremoRect  
MetalRect  
15  
15  
Fat bass and raging distorted sound.  
Selects an amplifier type to be simulated.  
Options: Brit800, TremoRect, MetalRect,  
Metal Panel Recti Amplifier  
1.Type  
ClassA30, Fatman (default: Brit800)  
See the table on the right for details  
about each type.  
Simulates the amp head of the high  
gain amp series, same as the Tremo  
Recti Amplifiers. Deep and well-sepa-  
rated distortion and heavy sound.  
Suitable for the metal sound.  
Adjusts the distortion gain.  
Range: 1 to 15 (The default depends on  
the distortion type selected. See the table  
on the right.)  
2. Amp Gain  
British Class A 30 Amplifier  
Simulates a most popular British  
sound tube amplifier.  
The preamp section is designed us-  
ing the class A circuit for creating  
the fat and warm sound.  
Usually used in the range between  
clear and crunch sound, but some-  
times used with the higher gain to  
get a harder distortion.  
Adjusts the low frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 10)  
3. Bass  
4. Middle  
5.Treble  
2
ClassA30  
Adjusts the mid frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 10)  
Adjusts the high frequency response.  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 10)  
Fat Bass Amplifier  
Simulates the American combo am-  
plifier designed as a bass amplifier  
but used by many guitarists because  
of its fat presence sound.  
Adjusts the presence (the feeling of be-  
ing "up front").  
Range: 0 to 10 (default: 0)  
6. Presence  
FatMan  
Suitable for jazz and blues with its  
clear and crunch sound, however,  
because you can get a raging distor-  
tion that you cannot expect from an  
ordinary bass amplifier when rais-  
ing the gain, It can be used for a wide  
range of genres.  
5
Turns on or off the noise gate.  
Options: OFF, 1 to 99 (default: OFF)  
7. Noise Gate  
8. Out Level  
Sets the output level of the distortion.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 80)  
Sets the delay time.  
Range: 5 ms to 1200 ms (default: 250 ms)  
• Parameters for distortion effects  
(Parameter type: MIC SIMULATION)  
Effect type No.44 (shown in "Effect type list" on page  
49) is the mic simulation type.  
This effect type has 3 parameters as shown below.  
9. DelayTime  
10. Feedback  
Sets the feedback level of the distortion.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 40)  
Sets the delay level.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 0)  
11. Delay Level  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
German Dynamic 421 (Low cut: 3)  
Selects a microphone input type.  
Options: US Dyn 58 (dynamic type), MCon2  
(condenser type)  
Simulates the sound of "GDyn 421" above  
with the Low Cut switch to On (3).  
You can suppress boosted low frequencies.  
GDyn 421 LC3  
GDyn 421 LC2  
1. IN  
Default: US Dyn 58  
German Dynamic 421 (Low cut: 2)  
Selects a microphone output type to be simu-  
lated.  
Simulates the sound of "GDyn 421" above  
with the Low Cut switch to On (2).  
You can suppress boosted low frequencies  
more than "GDyn 421 LC3".  
Options: TCon3k, TCon3k LC, TCon414,  
TCon414LC1,TCon414LC2,TDyn112, GDyn421,  
GDyn421LC3, GDyn421LC2, GDyn421LC1,  
GDyn421SPE, MCon1, MCon2, MConV, UsDyn58,  
VCon47,VCon87,VCon87 LC  
2. Out  
German Dynamic 421 (Low cut: 1)  
Simulates the sound of "GDyn 421" above  
with the Low Cut switch to On (1).  
You can suppress boosted low frequencies  
more than "GDyn 421 LC2".  
Default:VCon87  
See the next page for details.  
GDyn 421 LC1  
GDyn 421 SPE  
Adjusts the noise gate.  
Options: OFF, 0 to 99 (default: OFF)  
3. Gate  
German Dynamic 421 (Low cut: SPE)  
Simulates the sound of "GDyn 421" above  
with the Low Cut switch to On (SPE).  
You can considerably suppress boosted low  
frequencies. Suitable for a speech.  
Sets the output level.  
Range: 0 to 99 (default: 80)  
4. Out Level  
Details of microphone output types  
18 options are available for the microphone output  
type, as shown below.  
Modern Condenser 1  
Simulates the sound of a modern con-  
denser microphone which has a wider dy-  
namic range and bright sound. It offers a  
warm tube sound, making a vocal or acous-  
tic guitar as if it were recorded by a con-  
denser microphone.  
MCon 1  
Trad Condenser 3k (Low cut: Off)  
Simulates the sound of a multipurpose  
professional condenser microphone with  
a large diaphragm.  
TCon 3k  
Its warm and transparent sound is suit-  
able for a vocal, as well as a drum over-  
head or guitar amplifier.  
Modern Condenser 2  
Simulates the sound of a condenser micro-  
phone offering wide dynamic range, like  
"MCon 1". It offers a flat frequency re-  
sponse and natural sound.  
MCon 2  
MConV  
Trad Condenser 3k (Low cut: On)  
Simulates the sound of "TCon 3k" above  
with the Low Cut switch to On.  
You can suppress boosted low frequencies  
as a result from placing a microphone in  
close proximity to the signal source.  
TCon 3k LC  
Modern Condenser V  
Simulates the sound of a modern tube mi-  
crophone with vintage feel.  
It offers a deep and natural sound which  
only tube microphones can provide.  
Suitable for a vocal, piano and ensemble.  
Trad Condenser 414 (Low cut: On)  
Simulates the sound of one of the most  
popular condenser microphones in profes-  
TCon 414  
US Dynamic 58  
Simulates the most popular dynamic hand-  
held vocal microphone.  
sional studios together with the Classic  
condenser 87. You can get a high-fidelity  
clean sound of an acoustic piano.  
Us Dyn 58  
VCon 47  
VCon 87  
High-end and low-end frequencies are not  
extended as compared with a condenser  
microphone.  
Trad Condenser 414 (Low cut: 75 Hz)  
Simulates the sound of "TCon 414" above  
with the Low Cut switch to On (75 Hz).  
You can suppress boosted low frequencies.  
TCon 414 LC1  
Vintage Condenser 47  
Simulates a professional tube microphone  
with a large diaphragm that offers clean  
and dry sound.  
Trad Condenser 414 (Low cut: 150 Hz)  
Simulates the sound of "TCon 414" above  
with the Low Cut switch to On (150 Hz).  
You can suppress boosted low frequencies  
more than "TCon 414LC1".  
TCon 414 LC2  
TDyn 112  
Suitable for an acoustic guitar and brass.  
Vintage Condenser 87 (Low cut: Off)  
Simulates the sound of a classic and his-  
toric model used for vocals and strings fre-  
quently in professional studios.  
Provides outstanding warm sound among  
condenser microphones.  
Trad Dynamic 112  
Simulates the sound of a dynamic micro-  
phone suitable for a kick.  
You can get a clean and powerful sound  
by applying it to a kick or bass.  
It has a slightly boosted low frequencies.  
Vintage Condenser 87 (Low cut: On)  
Simulates the sound of "VCon 87" with low  
cut "On".  
You can suppress boosted low frequencies  
as a result from placing a microphone in  
close proximity to the signal source.  
German Dynamic 421  
Simulates the sound of a dynamic micro-  
phone which is frequently used for record-  
ing a tom-tom.  
Suitable for recording a skin percussion  
because of its powerful attack feeling with  
a high frequency peak.  
VCon 87 LC  
GDyn 421  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Digital recording  
You can digitally record an external digital source to the VF80, or stereo output signals of the VF80 to an external  
digital recorder. This section describes how to make digital recording between the VF80 and an external digital  
device. Note that the VF80 can only handle S/P DIF format digital data.  
Recording an external source onto theVF80 digitally  
The following describes how to record an external S/P DIF digital source (such as CD, MD and DAT) onto the  
VF80.  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF  
OUTPUT  
/
DATA  
INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
INPUT  
Selecting a track to record  
<Important note>  
• When recording a digital source onto the VF80, make  
sure that the source signal is the "44.1 kHz, 16-bit" S/P  
DIF digital format.  
Press the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] key ofTracks  
7/8.  
1
The key lighting in green change to flashing in red.  
• You can record an external S/P DIF digital source only  
onto Tracks 7/8 of the VF80. If you want to record it  
onto other tracks, first record it onto Tracks 7/8 and  
then move the data to other tracks using the track  
exchange function.  
Starting to record  
Set theTrack 7/8 and Master faders to the "0" position.  
1
2
Start recording of theVF80 by pressing the [PLAY] key  
while holding down the [RECORD] key,and start play-  
back of the external digital device.  
Selecting a program to be recorded  
Whenmorethanoneprogramexists, selectthedesired  
program using the program select function before re-  
cording.  
See "Selecting a program" in "Recorder function" about  
how to select a program.  
"When recording a digital signal, you cannot adjust the  
input level of the VF80." "To get the optimum record-  
ing level, adjust the output level of the source."  
The level meters for Tracks 7/8 on the screen shows  
the input levels.  
<Note>  
During digital recording, the level meters for the  
stereo outputs (L and R) are not active.  
Selecting the digital input  
In the "Digital In" menu of the setup mode,select "On."  
1
Rotating the [PHONES] knob clockwise to monitor the  
source sound.  
3
4
See "Setting digital input" in "Setup mode" about how to  
select "On."  
When set to "On", you can record an incoming S/P DIF  
signal from the [S/P DIF / DATA INPUT] connector onto  
Track 7/8 of the VF80.  
After finishing recording, stop theVF80 by pressing  
the [STOP] key , as well as stop the external digital de-  
vice.  
After setting "Digital In" menu,press the [EXIT/NO] key  
2
to exit the setup mode.  
<Note>  
When receiving a correct S/P DIF digital signal, "DIGI  
IN" is shown steadily on the screen. When a correct  
digital signal is not received, "DIGI IN" blinks on the  
screen. In such a case, check the connection and set-  
tings of the external source device.  
After you have finished the digital recording, return  
the "Digital In" setting to "Off."  
When "On", you cannot record any analog signal  
onto Tracks 7/8.  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Recording theVF80 stereo output signals digitally onto an external digital device  
You can record the stereo output signal digitally onto an external digital device via the [S/P DIF/DATA OUTPUT]  
connector.  
You do not have to carry out any special operation for outputting an S/P DIF digital signal from the [S/P DIF/  
DATA OUTPUT] connector, because it is always output there.  
All you have to do for mixing down to an external digital device digitally is to connect the device to the [S/  
P DIF/DATA OUTPUT] connector. You can perform the digital mixdown during the mixdown process described  
in "Mixdown" of the "Basic recording/playback" chapter as well as in the mastering mode described in "Master-  
ing mode" of this chapter.  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF  
OUTPUT  
/
DATA  
INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
INPUT  
MIDI clock sync system  
By setting any desired meter at any desired point of the programmable tempo map contained in the VF80, and  
by output of a MIDI clock and song position pointer according to the setting, a hardware type MIDI sequencer  
can be synchronized as a MIDI clock slave. Consequently, in this system, the VF80 will be the master and the MIDI  
sequencer the slave.  
MIDI clock & song position ponter  
MIDI IN  
MIDI Sound Source  
INPUT  
ST OUT L, R  
MIDI OUT  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
PUT  
BL  
B
PHONES  
R
Master Recorder  
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
MIDI IN  
MIDI OUT  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
MUTE  
PLAY  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
MIDI Sequencer  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
Set the MIDI sequencer forexternal sync mode  
2
Connecting external equipment  
(EXTERNAL SYNC) by MIDI clock.”  
Refer to the Owners Manual of the equipment in use  
for details.  
Connect theVF80 MIDI OUT to MIDI IN of the MIDI  
sequencer.  
1
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Executing of recording  
Setup of theVF80  
Various ways of recording can be conducted while  
synchronizing the VF80 and the MIDI sequencer with  
the MIDI clock.  
Because the MIDI clock and song position pointer will  
be output from theVF80, set the SETUP modeMIDI  
sync signal output settingtoCLK.”  
1
Refer to page “126”, SETUP mode “MIDI sync signal output  
setting” for correct operating procedures.  
Confirming the MIDI clock sync  
During recording and at playback following the  
recording,thetimebase(BAR/BEAT/CLK)isdisplayed  
in accordance to the setup tempo map, and the MIDI  
clock and song position pointer is also output.  
Confirm that the travel position (BAR/BEAT/CLK) of  
the VF08 and the travel position of the synchronized  
MIDI sequencer are matched.  
The meter in the desired bar can be set by “Time  
2
3
4
signature settingof the SETUP mode.  
Refertopage122”, SETUPmodeTimeSignatureSetting”  
for operating procedure.  
Tempo in the desired bar can be set by“Tempo setting”  
of the SETUP mode.  
Refer to page “124”, SETUP mode “Tempo Setting” for  
operating procedure.  
If correct sync cannot be obtained, re-check the  
connections/cables and setting of both equipment.  
Set the SETUP modeMetronome settingtoOn” if  
click sound is to be output according to the setup  
<Note>  
IntheVF80, theABS0positionissetat-002BAR/1BEAT  
/00CLK.” This setting is made in consideration of the  
time required (it will not sync immediately) for the MIDI  
sequencer, etc. to enter into sync. As a result, if the VF80  
is played back from ABS 0 (LOCATE ABS 0), sync will be  
completed by the time it reaches the first bar, and will  
thus synchronize from head of the tune.  
tempo map.  
Refer to page “125”, SETUP mode “Metronome setting” for  
operating procedure.  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL] key, and then change the  
time base display to BAR/BEAT/CLK.  
5
MTC sync/MIDI machine control system  
The following will explain synchronization by the MTC (MIDI time code) output and the computer controlling  
system using MMC (MIDI machine control). In this system, the VF80 will be the master and the computer (with  
sequence software) will be the slave. The VF80 will attach any desired offset (time difference) against ABS time  
(absolute time) and output it as MTC in any desired frame rate. It can also carry out the proper operation upon  
receiving an MMC from outside. In this case, because the VF80 can setup a DEVICE ID number by the SETUP mode  
MIDIDeviceIDSetting” menu, a multiple number of the VF80’s can be separately controlled by changing the DEVICE  
ID numbers in the transmitted message from the computer.  
MMC  
MIDI IN  
MIDI Sound Source  
MIDI IN  
MIDI OUT  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
PHONES  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
L
R
ST OUT L, R  
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
MIDI OUT  
MIDI IN  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
Master Recorder  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
Computer System  
with  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
MMC/MTC software  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK MASTER  
CURSOR  
MIDI OUT  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Connecting to external equipment  
<Notes on MTC related setups>  
By “MTC offset time setting” and “MTC offset mode setting,”  
at what position (ABS 0 or 001BAR/1BEAT/00CLK)  
should the setup MTC (MTC offset time) is to be output  
is set. When setting the start time of the tune in the  
sequence software by these setups, be careful of the  
following points.  
Connect theVF80 MIDI IN/OUT to the computer (with  
MIDI interface) MIDI IN/OUT.  
MMC/MTC complied sequence software is activated in  
the computer.  
1
1
• Offset mode: For ABS  
Setup of external equipment  
If playback is started from ABS 0, since MTC will be  
output starting from the MTC offset time that has been  
set, thestarttimeofthetunesetbythesequencesoftware  
must be set about 3 seconds later from the MTC offset  
time that was setup. This will provide time because the  
sequence software cannot sync immediately after MTC  
is output. For example, if the initial setting of “00h 59m  
57s 00f 00sf” is used, set the start time of the tune to “01h  
00m 00s 00f.”  
Setup the following in the sequence software.  
* Set to MTC external sync mode (EXTERNAL SYNC).  
* Set for output of MMC.  
* Set to the desired MTC read out frame rate.  
* Set start time of the tune (which MTC time is to be the first  
bar). Refer to precaution in regards to MTC offset, farther  
on.  
If playback is thus started from ABS 0 (LOCATE ABS 0),  
sync will be obtained by the time it reaches the first bar  
and therefore it can be made to sync from the head of  
the tune.  
For details, refer to Owners Manual of the external  
equipment.  
Setup of theVF80  
• Offset mode: For BAR  
As mentioned before, because the “ABS 0” position is set  
at the “002BAR / 1BEAT / 00CLK” position, the setup MTC  
offset time can be set to the head of the tune without  
taking into account the time until reaching sync, as  
mentioned above. The length of the time two bars  
beforehand will change in accordance to the first bar  
setting for “signature” and “tempo.” For example, it will  
be long if the tempo is set slow. This mode can be  
effectively applied when using the MIDI clock and MTC  
in parallel, and when using MTC for the sync signal while  
controlling the recorder with time base BAR/BEAT/CLK.  
BecauseMTCwillbeoutputfromtheVF80,setto“MTC”  
1
the SETUP modeMIDI sync signal output setting.”  
Refer to page “126”, SETUP mode “MIDI sync signal output  
setting” for operating procedure.  
Set a random offset time by the SETUP mode “MTC  
offset time setting.”  
Refer to page “127”, SETUP mode “MTC offset time setting”  
for operating procedure.  
2
3
IntheSETUPmode“MTCoffsetmodesetting,whether  
the MTC offset time setup in Step 2 should be output  
(ABS) at the ABS 00m 00s 00f 00sf position or at the  
Confirming MTC sync/MMC  
001BAR 1BEAT 00CLK (bar, signature) must be  
selected.  
Refer to page “127”, SETUP mode “MTC offset mode  
setting” for operating procedure.  
During recording and at playback after recording,time  
baseMTCisdisplayedaccordingtothesettingandMTC  
is output at the same time.  
Check that the VF80 traveling position (MTC) and the  
traveling position of the sequence software in sync are  
matched.  
1
Setup to the same frame rate as that setup by the  
sequence software byMTC Frame rate settingof the  
4
5
SETUP mode.  
Refer to page “126”, SETUP mode “MTC Frame rate setting”  
for operating procedure and details.  
2
Send MMC commands such as PLAY, STOP and  
LOCATE from the sequence software to see that the  
VF80 will be properly controlled.  
WhenacorrectMIDIcommand(MMCorFEX)isreceived,  
MIDI” in the display will be lit for about 40msec.  
There is no setting in the VF80 to receive MMC but it  
will operate if a correct MIDI signal is input.  
Set to the same figure as the sequence software MMC  
device number by the SETUP mode “MIDI device ID  
setting.”  
When the sequence software transmits by “7F,” it means  
ALL DEVICE” and therefore, it need not be setup.  
Refer to page “131”, SETUP mode “MIDI device ID setting”  
for operating procedure and details.  
If sync and control cannot be done correctly, re-check  
connections/cables and the setting of both equipment.  
Execution of recording  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL] key, and then change the  
time base display to MTC.  
6
Carry out various recordings while synchronizing the  
VF80 and a MIDI sequencer with the MIDI clock.  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
External MIDI equipment sync system by the slave mode  
Up to this point, synchronization with external MIDI equipment has been explained with the VF80 as the master  
and MIDI equipment as the slave but depending on the slave mode setting, the MIDI equipment can be set as the  
master and the VF80 as the slave.  
MTC  
Sound Source  
MIDI IN  
INPUT  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
PHONES  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
SCENE SCENE SEQ.  
TRACK  
EDIT  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
MIDI OUT  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
MUTE  
PLAY  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
Computer System  
with  
MMC/MTC software  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
Set slave mode to “On” by the SETUP mode “Slave  
mode setting.”  
4
Connection to external equipment  
Refer to page “128”, SETUP mode “Slave mode setting”  
for operating procedure and details.  
ConnectMIDIOUTofthecomputer(withMIDIinterface)  
with MIDI IN of theVF80.  
The computer sequence software complying to MMC/  
MTC must be activated.  
1
1
Set slave type toVariby the SETUP modeSlave type  
setting.”  
Refer to page “128”, SETUP mode “Slave type setting” for  
operating procedure and details.  
5
6
Setup of external equipment  
Sequence software is setup as follows.  
Press the [TIME BASE SEL] key, to change the time  
base display to MTC.  
* Set for output of MTC.  
* Set frame rate of the MTC to be output.  
* Confirm start time of the tune.  
Refer to Owners Manual of the respective equipment  
for details.  
Confirming chase lock  
When the sequence software is played, “CHASEand  
“MTCin the display will be light and the chase lock  
1
Setup of theVF80  
will be completed.  
Check that the MTC output by the sequence software  
and MTC time displayed in the VF80 are the same.  
Set to same frame rate as the sequence software by the  
1
2
3
SETUP modeMTC Frame rate setting.”  
Refertopage126”, SETUPmodeMTCFrameratesetting”  
for operating procedure and details.  
When the sequence software stops, MTC will be  
interrupted and theVF80 will also stop.  
CHASE” in the display will change from lit to blinking.  
2
3
Set to the desired mode by the SETUP mode “MTC  
offset mode setting.”  
Refer to page “127”, SETUP mode “MTC offset mode  
setting” for operating procedure and details.  
DuringFF/REWofthesequencesoftware,theVF80will  
remain stopped but upon starting to record, theVF80  
will immediately chase lock.  
Should it not be possible to chase lock, re-check  
connections / cables and all settings.  
A random offset time can be set by the SETUP mode  
“MTC offset time setting.”  
Refer to page “127”, SETUP mode “MTC offset time setting”  
for operating procedure and details.  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced Operations  
Execution of recording  
<Notes>  
• Chase lock of the VF80 by MTC only is permissible  
when speed difference of the MTC from the master is  
within +/- 5.6%.  
Carry out various recordings while the recorder is  
chase locked to the sequence software.  
Against the MTC within this range, variable pitch will  
be constantly applied internally for chasing. Chase  
lock, however, will not function against MTC at a speed  
difference outside this range. Also, when the master  
speed difference is large, it is advised to let the VF80  
learn the master speed by entering PLAY prior to  
recording. By doing so, it will be lock faster from the  
second and later sessions.  
<Precautions at MTC related setups>  
Theposition(ABS0or001BAR/1BEAT/00CLK)whenthe  
setup MTC (MTC offset time) should be output was setup  
by the “MTC offset time setting” and “MTC offset mode  
setting.” In accordance to start time of the tune set by  
the sequence software, setup as explained below.  
• Normally, when “Setup of slave type” is set to “Vari,”  
the VF80 will be constantly controlled by vari-pitch  
and follow the MTC, which is the master.  
However, if the digital input is set to “On” via the SETUP  
mode “Setup of digital input,” it will be in “Word clock  
external sync operation” by the digital signal (S/P DIF)  
that is input.  
Therefore, it must be noted that when “Setup of digital  
input” is executed, even though “Setup of slave type”  
is set to “Vari,” it will not follow by application of vari-  
pitch and upon completion of lock, it will change to  
external sync operation by the digital input signal.  
Offset mode: For ABS  
Set the MTC offset time about three seconds prior to the  
start time of the tune set by the sequence software.  
Because the recorder cannot immediately chase lock  
after input of MTC, in order to sync the unit from head  
of the tune, set the preroll using the sequence software,  
and playback from before the actual head of the tune to  
allow the recorder to enter into sync by the time it arrives  
at the head of the tune.  
Offset mode: For BAR/BEAT  
The MTC offset time can be set to the same time as the  
start time of the tune set by the sequence software.  
Because the “ABS 0” position is set at the “002BAR/1BEAT/  
00CLK” position in the unit, as mentioned before, the  
preceding time required for sync is already set.  
The preceding time of two bar lengths could change in  
lengthdependingonthefirstbar’ssignaturesettingand  
tempo setting” mentioned before. For example, it will  
be longer if the tempo is slowed down.  
<One Point Advice>  
Sync signal “Vari” of the “Slave mode setting” menu:  
When the VF80 is made to chase lock by MTC only,  
variable pitch will be constantly applied by external  
MTC. If a digital signal is output to an external digital  
equipment from the VF80, it will not be able to follow  
the speed difference (MTC speed difference of the  
master) of the VF80 and the external digital equipment,  
in some cases, may not be able to input a continuous  
digital signal.  
As a counter measure, the sync signal should be set to  
Free” by the “Slave mode setting” menu. Using this  
setting, the VF80 will enter self operation by the internal  
clock, after completion of chase lock, and it will be  
possible to supply a stable digital signal to the external  
equipment.  
Under this setting, when MTC drift between the master  
recorder and slave recorder exceeds 10 frames, the VF80  
will assume that chase lock has been disengaged and the  
slave recorder will carry out position matching again  
with the master unit (re-chase operation).  
During the re-chase operation, sound output will be  
muted and the digital signal will also be interrupted.  
If it is within 10 frames, the slave recorder will continue  
to run while admitting this drift.  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Save/Load of song data  
You can save or load song data (including audio and setup data) using a digital audio recorder via the S/P DIF  
digital signal, as well as using a optional CD-RW drive (Model CD-1A).  
This function allows you to save finished or unfinished song data to a digital recorder or a optional CD-RW  
drive, and load the data later.  
******About song data******  
There are two methods of saving/loading song data depending on the digital signals used to handle the  
data, which are S/PDIF digital and CD-RW drive. The data format and time required for the save/load  
operations are different between each method.  
•Using the S/PDIF digital signal (you can save/load data for each program individually.):  
Following to five seconds of the pilot signal (shown in gray in the diagram below), the song data is output to an  
external digital audio device such as a DAT recorder.  
The audio data is divided into data blocks of track pairs (shown in black in the diagram below) and transferred.  
To save data for Real tracks 1 through 8, 4 two-track data are transferred. To save all tracks including the Additional  
tracks in addition to the Real tracks, 12 two-track data are transferred. Therefore, it will take about 4 times as much  
as the recorded time of a program (from ABS 0 to REC END) to save the Real tracks 1 through 8 of the program, while  
it will take about 12 times to save all the data including the Additional tracks.  
When loading song data from the external device to the VF80 via the S/PDIF digital signal, data is transferred with  
two-track data blocks, as with the same way as saving data from the VF80 to the external device. (See also <Notes>  
on the next page.)  
Trk 23&24  
Trk 3&4  
Trk 21&22  
Trk 1&2  
Program 2 (P02)  
Program 1 (P01)  
Program 99 (P99)  
•Using a CD-RW/CD-R disc (you can save/load data for each program individually.):  
See the following <Note>.  
When using a CD-RW/CD-R discs, all audio data including both the Real and Additional tracks (shown in black in  
the diagram below) is transferred simultaneously. Therefore, you can save or load a program much faster than  
using the S/PDIF signal. Note that no pilot tone or beep sound is recorded when saving data to a CD-RW/CD-R discs.  
If song data to be saved requires more space than the available disk space, you can save the data to more than one  
disk (up to 99 disks). You can also save/load data by the WAV file format. In the save/load operation using the  
WAV file, you can specify any track(s) to be saved or loaded, as well as all tracks.  
Trk 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 & 6 &7  
& 8 & 9 & 10 & 11 & 12 & 13  
& 14 & 15 & 16 & 17 & 18 &  
19 & 20 & 21 & 23 & 24  
Program 2 (P02)  
Program 1 (P01)  
Program 99 (P99)  
<Note>  
To save/load using a CD-RW/CD-R disc, you must install the optional CD-RW drive  
in the VF80.  
For the detailed information about the CD-RW drive, contact your dealer or the  
nearest FOSTEX sales office. See 134 page about how to install the CD-RW drive in  
the VF80.  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
<Items that can be saved or loaded as song data>  
•Memory data:  
AUTO PUNCH IN/OUT data and Start/End/To points,  
Scene memories 00 through 99, Marks 00 through 99 (only can be saved/loaded using CD-RW drive)  
•Timebase:  
ABS, MTC or BAR/BEAT/CLK  
•Setup mode:  
Bar/beat setting, tempo setting, metronome on/off, preroll time, MIDI synchronization output signal  
setting, MTC offset time, MTC offset mode, REC protect setting, slave mode on/off, and slave type setting  
Fader fix mode setting, fader recall mode setting  
<Items that cannot be saved or loaded as song data>  
•On/off settings for auto play mode and auto return mode  
•Vari pitch on/off and pitch data  
•Setup mode:  
DIGITAL IN and DIGITAL OUT settings, bar/beat resolution on/off setting, device ID setting and drive  
select setting  
Saving/loading data using the S/PDIF digital signal  
<Notes for digital audio recorders to be used>  
The VF80 song data only can be saved to or loaded from digital recorders that can handle 16 bit, 44.1 kHz  
linear digital data with S/PDIF format (such as DAT recorders).  
<Notes for saving data using the S/PDIF digital signal>  
When saving all data including both real and Additional track data using the S/PDIF digital signal, note the  
following.  
Only the data recorded within the time duration between ABS 0 and REC END of the Real tracks is saved.  
Therefore, if the recorded time of Additional tracks is longer than the Real tracks, only the Additional track data  
within the time duration between ABS 0 and REC END of the Real tracks is saved.  
In the example shown on the right, the Additional  
tracks have data from "00m 00s" to "10m 00s", while  
the Real tracks have data from "00m 00s" to "07m 00s".  
Real Tracks  
If you are going to save all tracks, the Additional track  
data from "00m 00s" to "07m 00s" will be saved but  
the rest will not be saved.  
Save  
In such a case, you can solve the problem by setting  
DAT  
the time length of saved data to 10 minutes by using  
the "Save Length" screen mentioned later (see "step  
Additional  
Tracks  
4" on page 99). Note that the maximum save length  
is 59 minutes 59 seconds.  
The other way to solve the problem is to exchange  
the Additional track data and the Real track data  
before saving data. You should be careful not to lose  
the Additional track data in this operation. See page  
68 about the "track exchange operation".  
seven minutes  
REC END (10m 00s)  
of additional track  
REC END (07m 00s)  
of real track  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Saving data using the S/PDIF digital signal  
You can save data using the S/PDIF digital signal via the [S/P DIF DATA OUTPUT] (coaxial) jack.  
• Use an external digital recorder that supports 44.1 kHz sampling frequency (the same as the VF80,  
Connecting to an external digital recorder  
Saving data  
Connect the [S/P DIF DATA OUTPUT] jack to the digital  
You can save data via the "Save PGM" menu in the  
setup mode.  
input jack of the external digital recorder (DAT, etc.).  
<Details about "Save PGM" menu>  
<Note>  
• Output signal options: S/PDIF and IDE (CD-1A)  
• Program options:  
• Track options:  
* When using S/PDIF:  
Tracks 1-8, Tracks 1-16, Tracks 1-24, Tracks 9-16, Tracks 9-24  
or Tracks 17-24.  
P01 to P99 (an individual Program)  
Do not do anything, such as unplug the connecting  
cable, that interrupts the digital signal until the saving  
operation is completed. Otherwise, the unit may  
generates a noise which damages an external recorder.  
VF80  
* When using IDE (CD-1A):  
All tracks (1-24) is selected automatically. (You can select tracks  
individually when saving by the WAV file format).  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF  
OUTPUT  
/
DATA  
INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
INPUT  
Press the [SETUP] key to enter the setup mode.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the setup  
menu.  
1
2
S/P DIF DATA OUTPUT  
Use the [JOG] dial to select "Save PGM" and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the device  
to which the data is saved. "IDE" flashes.  
Digital equipment  
• If your digital recorder only provide the optical digital  
input jack and does not provide the coaxial jack, use  
the optional COP-1 (optical/coaxial converter).  
• Do not connect digital signals for both directions  
between the VF80 and the external recorder (i.e. the  
digital output of the VF80 to the digital input of the  
external recorder and the digital output of the external  
recorder to the digital input of the VF80), which may  
form a digital loop and cause feedback.  
Setting the external recorder  
Flashing  
Set the sampling frequency to 44.1 kHz (the same as  
the VF80).  
1
Set the input source to "digital input" to accept the  
signal from the VF80.  
Some machine also needs to select the clock reference  
to "external" when setting the input source to "digital  
input". See the operation manual of the machine for  
the detailed information.  
2
• "IDE" should be selected when saving or loading data via  
CD-RW/CD-R.  
Use the [JOG] dial or [CURSOR] keys to select  
3
"SPDIF" and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the program  
to be saved.  
The program number currently selected flashes, while  
the data size of the program is shown.  
While a program number is flashing, you can select  
the desired program to be saved.  
<Note>  
If you cannot hear the input signal or you hear  
digital noise when monitoring the source signal of  
the external digital recorder, check the connections,  
cables and settings of both the VF80 and the external  
recorder.  
• See the operation manual of the external recorder for the  
detailed information.  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
<Note>  
When you save tracks including Additional tracks,  
read <Notes for saving data using the S/PDIF digital  
signal> on page 97 before executing the save  
operation.  
Flashing  
After selecting tracks, press the [ENTER/YES] key  
again.  
7
Use the [JOG] dial to select the program to be saved  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows "Rec Start Recorder!" together with  
the program and tracks to be saved, and "Sure?"  
flashes. If you are sure to start saving data to the  
recorder, go on to the next step.  
4
The display shows the "Save Length" screen.  
Initially, the recorded time length of the selected  
program (ABS 00 to REC END) is shown as the time  
length of data saving. Normally you do not need to  
edit the length but you may edit it to the desired value  
if needed.  
Flashing  
Flashing  
After checking all preparations on the external  
8
9
recorder are made, start it recording.  
It may be a good idea to put a Start-ID (for DAT) or  
set a locate memory at the starting position so that  
you can easily find the position when you load the  
data later.  
For example, if the actual recorded time is 9 min. 00  
sec., you can make the length of the data to be saved  
shorter or longer than 9 min. 00 sec., as long as the  
length does not exceed 59 min.59 sec.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key immediately after the  
external recorder starts recording.  
The initially displayed value here is the length of the  
Real track, therefore, as noted earlier, you may edit  
the value to match the length of the Additional track  
if it is longer.  
The display shows something like the one below. After  
a few seconds, the unit starts saving the data and "Wait  
time" starts counting down.  
To edit the save length  
Use the [CURSOR] keys to move the flashing field  
between "minutes" and "seconds".  
Use the [JOG] dial to set the value for the flashing  
field.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting tracks to  
be saved.  
5
For the first several seconds, the VF80 transmits the  
pilot signal that will be a reference for locating the  
tape position during the load operation, and the actual  
data saving starts from the position at which "Wait  
Time" starts counting down.  
Data is saved in 2-track unit. When the data saving is  
completed, "Completed!" appears on the screen and  
the VF80 stops.  
Flashing  
<Note>  
If you interrupts saving before completing, the saved  
data is invalid.  
Select tracks to be saved.  
Use the [CURSOR] keys to move the blinking field  
between "From" and "To".  
6
Stop the external recorder.  
Use the [JOG] dial to set the track number for the  
blinking field.  
10  
11  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or the [STOP] key)  
repeatedly until exiting the setup mode.  
For the "From" field, you can select from 1, 9 and 17.  
For the "To" field, you can select a higher value than  
the "From" field value among 8, 16 and 24.  
Accordingly, you can set "Save Track Area" to one of  
the following.  
• To cancel each operation or to return to the previous  
screen before pressing the [ENTER/YES] key, press the  
[EXIT/NO] key (or the [STOP] key). Each press of the  
key returns to the previous screen level and finally  
exits the setup mode.  
"From 1 To 8", "From 1 to 16", "From 1 To 24", "From 9 To  
16", "From 9 To 24", and "From 17 To 24"  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Loading data using the S/PDIF signal  
You can load data using the S/PDIF digital signal via the [S/P DIF DATA INPUT] (coaxial) jack.  
*Use an external recorder that supports 44.1 kHz sampling frequency (the same as the VF80).  
Connecting to an external recorder  
Loading data  
Connect the [S/P DIF DATA INPUT] jack to the digital  
You can load data via the "Load PGM" menu in the  
output jack of the external digital recorder.  
setup mode.  
<Details about "Load PGM" menu>  
• Input signal options: S/PDIF and IDE (CD-1A)  
<Note>  
Do not do anything, such as unplug the coaxial cable,  
that interrupts the digital signal until the loading  
operation is completed. Otherwise, the unit may  
generates a noise which damages an external recorder.  
• Program options:  
• Track options:  
P01 to P99 (an individual Program)  
* When using S/PDIF:  
Tracks 1-8, Tracks 1-16, Tracks 1-24, Tracks 9-16, Tracks 9-24  
or Tracks 17-24.  
* When using IDE (CD-1A):  
All tracks (1-24) is selected automatically. (You can select tracks  
individually when saving by the WAV file format).  
VF80  
POWER  
PHANTOM  
ON OFF  
S/P DIF  
OUTPUT  
/
DATA  
INPUT  
MIDI  
OUTPUT  
Press the SETUP key to enter the setup mode.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the setup  
menu.  
INPUT  
1
2
S/P DIF DATA INPUT  
Use the [JOG] dial to select "Load PGM" and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the recorder  
from which the data is loaded. "IDE" flashes.  
Digital Equipment  
• If your digital recorder only provide the optical digital  
input jack and does not provide the coaxial jack, use  
the optional COP-1 (optical/coaxial converter).  
• Do not connect digital signals for both directions  
between the VF80 and the external recorder (i.e. the  
digital output of the VF80 to the digital input of the  
external recorder and the digital output of the external  
recorder to the digital input of the VF80), which may  
form a digital loop and cause feedback.  
Flashing  
Setting the external recorder  
Use the [JOG] dial or [CURSOR] keys to set "Load  
Device Select" to "SPDIF" and press the [ENTER/YES]  
key.  
3
Make preparations of the external recorder for  
outputting the digital signal.  
1
The display shows the screen for selecting a load  
destination program to which data is loaded.  
A program number currently selected blinks, followed  
by its program name. The data size of the current  
program is also shown. When a program number is  
flashing, you can select the desired load destination  
program.  
Locate the beginning of the pilot signal for the song  
data.  
2
• See the operation manual of the external recorder for the  
detailed information.  
Flashing  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
You can select a load destination program from existing  
programs on the current drive as well as "New PGM".  
When selecting "New PGM", a new program is created.  
When the VF80 is locking to the digital input signal,  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows "Play Start Player!".  
7
• If you load data to a program in which data is  
already recorded, the newly loaded data  
overwrites the current data track by track.  
Consequently, on each overwritten track, the  
loaded data becomes valid while the current data  
is erased.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the program to which  
4
data is loaded and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting tracks to  
be loaded.  
Start playback of the external recorder.  
After reading the pilot signal recorded when saving  
the data, the data starts loading automatically.  
When starts loading, the display shows something like  
the one below, in which "Wait time" starts counting  
down.  
8
Flashing  
Select tracks to be loaded.  
Use the [CURSOR] keys to move the flashing field  
between "From" and "To".  
5
Use the [JOG] dial to set the track number for the  
flashing field.  
For the "From" field, you can select from 1, 9 and 17.  
For the "To" field, you can select from 8, 16 and 24.  
For example, if you select "From 1 to 24", data for all  
tracks (1 to 24) will be loaded.  
Data is loaded in 2-track unit.  
While loading, the [TRACK STATUS/TRACK SEL] keys  
for channels 1 and 2 flash, while the input levels are  
displayed by level meters 1 and 2.  
When the data loading is completed, "Completed!"  
appears on the screen.  
After selecting tracks, press the [ENTER/YES] key  
6
again.  
<Note>  
The display shows something like the one below. A  
load destination program (existing or new program)  
to which the data is loaded and tracks to be loaded  
are shown, while "Sure?" flashes.  
If you quit loading before completing, the loaded  
data is invalid.  
Stop the external recorder.  
9
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or the [STOP] key)  
repeatedly until exiting the setup mode.  
10  
Flashing  
• To cancel each operation or to return to the previous  
screen before pressing the [ENTER/YES] key, press the  
[EXIT/NO] key (or the [STOP] key). Each press of the  
key returns to the previous screen level and finally  
exits the setup mode.  
<Note>  
In the above step, if the VF80 does not lock to the  
digital signal from the external digital recorder, the  
following warning message appears on the display,  
showing that the VF80 does not receive a correct S/  
PDIF digital signal. So check the cable connection and  
the digital output setting of the external digital  
recorder.  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Save/Load using CD-RW/CD-R  
By installing the optional CD-RW drive (Model CD-1A) to the VF80, you can save or load data in the  
FDMS-3 or WAV file format using a CD-RW/CD-R disc. In addition, you can create an audio CD (CD-  
DA) or load audio data from an audio CD.  
Please read the notes below first before performing the save/load operation.  
Please read this first!  
Save/load of Song Data Using a CD-RW drive  
The save/load operation using a CD-RW/CD-R disk is performed in the following manners.  
• Save  
You can only a single selected program data to a  
disc regardless of the program data amount.  
You cannot save more than one program data even  
if there are enough disc space.  
However, you can save a program data to more  
than one disc if the data amount is larger than a  
disc space.  
Save  
Trk 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 & 6 &7  
& 8 & 9 & 10 & 11 & 12 & 13  
& 14 & 15 & 16 & 17 & 18 &  
19 & 20 & 21 & 23 & 24  
As shown on the right, you can save almost all  
necessary information such as song data of all  
tracks (real and additional tracks) and mixer scene  
data.  
Program 2 (P02)  
Program 99 (P01)  
Program 1 (P01)  
Current drive of the VF80  
• Load  
Trk 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 & 6 &7  
& 8 & 9 & 10 & 11 & 12 & 13  
& 14 & 15 & 16 & 17 & 18 &  
19 & 20 & 21 & 23 & 24  
The data loading using a CD-RW drive is taken  
place after a “new program” is created in the cur-  
rent drive (the load destination).  
You cannot overwrite an existing program with  
the loaded data.  
Load  
Program 2 (P02)  
New Program  
Program 1 (P01)  
The newly created program is numbered the next  
number to the highest existing program number.  
Current drive of the VF80  
• Creating an audio CD  
You can make an audio CD by recording sound data of tracks 1 and 2 between the “Start point” and “End  
point” to a CD-RW/CD-R disc. It is also possible to record some mastered materials continuously.  
• Loading an audio CD data  
You can load a material on a (commercial or created) audio CD to a program of the VF80.  
Audio data is loaded to a “new program” automatically created by the VF80, which is the same way as  
backup data loading. The VF80 never overwrites the existing program.  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
<Care and handling of CD-RW/CD-R discs>  
With an optional CD-RW drive, you can use not only CD-RW discs but also CD-R discs. Note that  
CD-R discs has some restrictions as shown below.  
CD-R disc  
CD-RW disc  
You can save (record) data to a disc as many times  
required. Note that when saving new data, it is recorded  
after the previously recorded data is erased. In other  
words, every time you save new data, all disc data is  
rewritten. (See “Saving data” described later.)  
You can save (record) data to a disc only once.  
You cannot save data to a recorded disc. You can, of  
course, load data as many times as required.  
<Note>  
A CD-RW/CD-R disc on which VF80 data is recorded can only be played by Fostex machines. Do not  
play it by non-Fostex devices. The drive or system used may be damaged.  
However, a CD-RW/CD-R disc with audio CD format created by the Fostex machine can be played by  
general machines such as audio CD players. (If an audio CD is made using a CD-RW disc, it can be played  
back only by a player that supports CD-RW playback.You cannot playback such a disc by a conventional CD  
player that does not support CD-RW playback.)  
<About data writing and reading speeds for data save/load>  
The writing and reading speeds for data save and load of the VF80 are automatically set as below.  
• Writing speed: according to a CD-RW drive used, however the maximum speed is 8 times.  
• Reading speed: according to a CD-RW drive used.  
The writing speed depends on a CD-RW drive but it is limited to 8 times.  
For save/load of the VF80 data, use discs that can be written at 4 times or higher speed. Do not use  
discs that only can be written at real-time or twice speed.  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Saving data using a CD-RW drive (Backup)  
The following procedure describes how to save FDMS-3 song data.  
We assume that the optional CD-RW drive (Model CD-1A) is already installed to the VF80 and a virgin CD-RW  
or CD-R disc is set.  
<Note>  
Do not carry out any VF80 key operation until the ac-  
cess process to the CD-RW/CD-R disc is completed.  
flashing  
After turning on the VF80, insert a disc to the CD-RW  
1
drive.  
While “BkUp” flashing, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting a backup  
mode (between FDMS-3 and WAV), where “WAV” is  
flashing.  
Press the [SETUP] key of the VF80 to enter the setup  
mode.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the setup  
menu.  
2
5
flashing  
Use the [CURSOR <] key to select (highlight)FDMS3”  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting a program  
to be saved (the program number of the selected pro-  
gram flashes).  
6
Use the [JOG] dial to select (highlight) “Save PGM”  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting a save de-  
vice, where “IDE” is flashing.  
3
Flashing  
recorded  
space  
By rotating the [JOG] dial, you can select a desired  
program number/title from among available programs  
in the VF80 current drive. The recorded space of the  
selected program is also shown.  
If you select a program which requires more than one  
disc for saving, the display shows the required num-  
ber of discs (see the screen example below).  
Flashing  
While “IDE” is flashing, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
After briefly showing the model name of the connected  
CD-RW drive, the display shows the screen for select-  
ing a save mode, where “BkUp” (backup) is flashing.  
4
number of  
discs  
To save (backup) song data, select “BkUp”.  
To make an audio CD, select “CD-DA” or “Setup”.  
After selecting a program, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen as below.  
7
This procedure describes how to save song data, so  
we select “BkUp” here.  
See “making an audio CD” described later for details  
about how to make an audio CD.  
Flashing  
flashing  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
In the example above, the selected program data will  
be saved to a CD-RW/CD-R disc with the backup num-  
ber “B01”. The program title is copied to the backup  
title (you can not edit it).  
By rotating the [JOG] dial when the above screen is  
shown, you can also select “Eject”, besides “B01”.  
If you select “Eject” and then press the [ENTER/YES]  
key, the disc will be ejected.  
<About save error>  
If an error occurs for some reason during the save  
operation, the error message as below appears.  
If it appears, press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The display returns to the previous screen before  
performing the save operation.  
Note that saved data before the error message ap-  
pears is all invalid.  
While “B01” is shown, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The VF80 starts the save operation.  
8
The recorded space shown on the display is counted  
down while the save operation progresses.  
It will take some time for saving all data. The follow-  
ing display example shows that the data of the se-  
lected program number is being saved to the backup  
number“B01”.  
<Note>  
If the message above appears while saving data  
to a CD-R disc, you can no longer use the disc.  
When completing the save operation, “Save Com-  
pleted!” appears on the display (as shown below) and  
the VF80 stops access to the drive, while the disc in  
the CD-RW drive is automatically ejected.  
<Hint 1>  
In the description for saving data above, we assume  
to use a non-recorded CD-RW/CD-R disc.  
If you use a recorded disc (including a disc on which  
computer data is recorded), also note the following.  
By performing step 5 in the save operation proce-  
dure shown above (“While “BkUp” is flashing, press  
the [ENTER/YES] key”.) When a recorded disc is in-  
serted, the display shows a warning message, fol-  
lowed by the confirmation screen (where “Sure?”  
flashes).  
When saving data to more than one disc, the first disc  
will be ejected when it is full (i.e. there is no more  
recording space on the disc), while “Insert Disk!” ap-  
pears on the screen.  
With this screen, you can choose whether erasing  
the recorded data or ejecting the disc.  
After inserting the second disc, the VF80 automati-  
cally resumes the save operation.  
After completing the save operation, the final disc is  
ejected and the above screen appears. (See <Note> be-  
low).  
<Note>  
You cannot abort the save operation before com-  
pleted. Especially during the save operation to  
more than one disc, if you happen to press the  
[EXIT/NO] key while removing or inserting a disc,  
you have to redo the save operation from the  
beginning with the first disc.  
Flashing  
Flashing  
<Note for saving data to more than one disc>  
If you save data to more than one disc, we rec-  
ommend to put a number on each disc in the  
saving order (such as DISC-1, DISC-2, etc.) so  
that you will easily know the order for inserting  
discs when loading data.  
To erase the existing (recorded) data  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while both “ERASE” and  
“Sure?” are flashing.  
The display shows the screen below and the VF80  
starts erasing the disc.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or the [STOP] key) to exit  
the Setup mode.  
As the erase process progresses, the number of  
flashing “ * ” increases from left to right.  
9
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Flashing  
Flashing  
Increases as the process progresses.  
Immediately after completing erasing the disc, the  
display shows the same screen (for selecting a pro-  
gram to be saved) which appears after step 5 is  
performed. Hereafter, perform the same proce-  
dure as described above.  
To eject the disc  
Use the [JOG] dial to highlight “Eject” (flashing)  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The disc is ejected while the display shows “Insert  
Disk!”.  
By inserting a disc, you can start the save opera-  
tion again from the beginning.  
<Hint 2>  
If you try to save data to a recorded CD-R disc, the  
display shows a warning message saying “Not Writ-  
able”, followed by a message saying “Insert Disk” as  
below.  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Loading backup data from a CD-RW drive  
The following procedure describes how to load FDMS-3 song data.  
We assume that the optional CD-RW drive (Model CD-1A) is already installed to the VF80 and a CD-RW or CD-  
R disc on which the song data is recorded is set.  
While “IDE” is flashing, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
4
<Note>  
After briefly showing the model name of the connected  
CD-RW drive, the display shows the screen for select-  
ing a load mode, where “BkUp” (backup) is flashing.  
Do not carry out any VF80 key operation until  
the access process to the CD-RW/CD-R disc is  
completed.  
To load song data saved, select“BkUp”.  
To load a material from an audio CD, select “CD-DA”.  
After turning on both the VF80, insert the disc to the  
CD-RW drive.  
1
This procedure describes how to load song data, so  
we select “BkUp” here.  
<Note>  
See “Loading from an audio CD” described later for de-  
tails about how to load a material from an audio CD.  
If you load song data which is saved to more  
than one disc, set DISC-1 first.  
If you set the other disc and go on the follow-  
ing procedure, the VF80 automatically recog-  
nized that the disc order i s not correct and  
the display shows “Wrong Disk”, followed by  
“Illegal No!” momentarily, and the disc is au-  
tomatically ejected.  
Flashing  
Press the [SETUP] key to enter the setup mode.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the setup  
menu.  
WhileBkUpis flashing, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the backup number and title, as  
well as recorded space.  
2
5
Flashing  
By rotating the [JOG] dial, you can select a desired  
program number/title from among available programs  
in the VF80 current drive. You can also select “Eject”.  
If you select “Eject” and press the [ENTER/YES] key,  
the disc is ejected  
Use the [JOG] dial to select (highlight) “Load PGM”  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting a load de-  
vice, where “IDE” is flashing.  
3
When you load song data which is saved to more  
than one disc, the display also shows the disc num-  
ber currently set. The example below shows DISC-  
1 is set.  
Flashing  
Light up  
Flashing  
While the desired backup number/title is shown on  
6
the display, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for creating a new pro-  
gram on the current drive, to which data will be loaded  
(“New PGM” lights).  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Light up  
Flashing  
Flashing  
As described earlier, when loading data from a CD-  
RW drive, the VF80 creates a new program on the  
current drive, which is the load destination.  
Therefore, “New PGM” is shown on the right of the  
flashing program number.  
When loading data from more than one disc, the first  
disc will be ejected immediately after all disc data has  
been loaded, while “Insert Disk!” appears on the screen.  
After inserting the second disc, the VF80 automati-  
cally resumes the load operation.  
The program number for the newly created destina-  
tion program is the next number to the highest exist-  
ing program number.  
After completing loading all the discs, the above screen  
appears.  
For example, if there are 8 existing programs (“P01”  
through “P08”) on the current drive, the newly cre-  
ated program is numbered “P09”.  
<Note>  
You cannot abort the load operation before com-  
pleted.  
<Note>  
If you rotate the [JOG] dial while the above screen  
(“Destn PGM Select”) is shown, you can select an  
existing program on the current drive as the desti-  
nation. However, as mentioned earlier, when load-  
ing data using CD-RW you cannot actually load  
data to the existing program by overwriting the  
program data.  
If you press the [ENTER/YES] key (see the next step)  
while selecting an existing program as the destina-  
tion, the display shows “Void!” and the VF80 ig-  
nores the operation.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or the [STOP] key) to exit  
the setup mode.  
8
<About load error>  
If an error occur for some reason during the  
load operation, the error message as below ap-  
pears.  
If it appears, press the [EXIT/NO] key.  
The display returns to the previous screen be-  
fore performing the load operation.  
Note that loaded data before the error message  
appears is all invalid.  
While “New PGM” is shown, press the [ENTER/YES]  
key.  
7
The VF80 starts the load operation.  
The recorded space shown on the display is counted  
down while the load operation progresses.  
It will take some time for loading all data.  
The following display example shows that the data of  
the backup number “B01” is being loaded to “P08”  
which is newly created on the current drive.  
<Display example for loading>  
<Note>  
If there is not enough available space for loading  
on the current drive, the display shows “Disk Full!”  
and the display returns to the previous screen.  
When completing the load operation, “Load Com-  
pleted!” appears on the display (as shown below) and  
the VF80 stops access to the drive, while the disc in  
the CD-RW drive is automatically ejected.  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Saving a WAV file  
Song data can be saved to or load from a CD-R/CD-RW disc by the FDMS-3 (Fostex Disk Management System-  
3) format, as well as by the WAV file format. As you can handle song data of the VF80 with a WAV file, it is  
possible to directly import/export data from/to a personal computer, to playback/edit a data file with various  
software applications, and to import a data file edited by a computer to the VF80.  
<Important notes for using a WAV file>  
About directory of a backup disk:  
• A WAV file saved is recorded in the root directory (in the first layer) on the backup disk.  
• A WAV file that can be loaded must be allocated in the root directory on the backup disk.  
A WAV file moved from the root directory to another area such as a folder cannot be recognized by the  
VF80, which may cause a malfunction.  
About file names of WAV files  
• A WAV file the VF80 saves is recorded with a file name "******##.WAV".  
• A WAV file the VF80 can load must have a file name "******##.WAV".  
The first 6 characters "******" are the title that is shown in the "Title Edit" screen in the setup mode.  
These characters can be changed when saving using a WAV file or edited by a computer.  
The following 2 characters "##" indicate the track number (1 to 24) for the save/load using a WAV file.  
The last ". WAV" is the file extension indicating that the file format is WAV.  
The VF80 does not recognize other file names than above. See the following description for each  
operation about details.  
By using the specifications above, you can load only the desired tracks of a WAV file or load a track-  
swapped WAV file. See "Loading a WAV file" described later for details.  
You can save a WAV file. The following procedure assumes that the newly CD-RW/CD-R disk is used for  
backup.  
Press the [SETUP] key to enter the setup mode.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the Setup  
menu.  
While "WAV" is flashing, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting On or Off  
of the Edit Source Export function, where "Off" flashes.  
You can switches between On and Off by using the  
[CURSOR] keys .  
1
4
Use the [JOG] dial to select "Save PGM" and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
2
The display shows the screen for selecting the device  
to which the data is saved. "IDE" flashes.  
Flashing  
Flashing  
If you save all data from "ABS 0" to "REC END" (in  
most cases), you do not have to change the setting  
here.  
While "IDE" is flashing, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the backup  
mode (FDMS 3 or WAV), where "WAV" flashes.  
<About the Edit Source Export function>  
The Edit Source Export function allows you to save  
the desired range of data between the Start and  
End points which are set when executing the Copy-  
paste or Move-paste function.  
3
Therefore, if you want to save only the specific range  
of data, you have to register the Start and End points  
before the save operation.  
See "Track Editing" in "Recorder Function" for  
details about how to set the Start and End points.  
Flashing  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
After selecting the track(s), press the [ENTER/YES]  
key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting a WAV file  
on the disk.  
7
<Note>  
If you save all data from "ABS 0" to "REC END", make  
sure to set the Edit Source Export function to Off.  
If no file is recorded on the disk, "WAV" and "Sure?"  
flashes. You can select "Eject" by rotating the [JOG]  
dial. To remove the disk, select "Eject" and press the  
[ENTER/YES] key.  
While "Off" is blinking, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting a program  
to be saved. The program number currently selected  
flashes, while the data size of the program is shown.  
5
Flashing  
Flashing  
Flashing  
<Hints>  
Use the [JOG] dial to select a program to be saved  
If the backup disk contains any existing program(s)  
previously saved, the display may show following  
screens after carrying out the previous step, depending  
on the available space of the backup disk.  
6
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting a track to  
be saved. Initially, "All Track" flashes.  
•Showing the title and "New File":  
There is enough space for creating a new WAV file in  
addition to the existing WAV files on the disk.  
Pressing the [ENTER/YES] key advances to the next step  
(for editing the file name).  
Flashing  
After completing the save operation, this new WAV file  
will be added on the disk.  
By rotating the [JOG] dial (or press the [CURSOR] </>  
key), you can select "From ** To **" (where the left field  
flashes initially) instead of "All Track".  
If you save data for all tracks (1 through 24), select  
"All Track". If you save data for any specific track(s),  
select "From ** To **" and specify the desired track  
numbers.  
•Showing the title and "New File", and "-****MB"  
alternately:  
The space for adding a new WAV file to the existing  
WAV files on the disk is ****MB short.  
Pressing the [ENTER/YES] key shows "Disk Full!",  
followed by "Delete All WAV?".  
Flashing  
Pressing the [ENTER/YES] key again deletes all the WAV  
file on the disk and advances to the next step (for  
editing the file name)  
After completing the save operation, only this new WAV  
file will remain on the disk.  
<To specify the desired tracks to "From ** To **">  
By rotating the [JOG] dial while the left ("From") field  
is flashing, you can select the track number from 01  
through 24. The number in the right ("To") field  
automatically follows the number in the left field (i.e.  
numbers in the left and right fields are always the same).  
Therefore, if you want to save a single track, you just  
have to set the right ("From") field and do not have to  
set the right ("To") field. For example, "From 02 To 02"  
will save only track 2.  
To specify tracks 5 through 12:  
•Enter "05" to the left field while the left field is  
flashing.  
•Press the [CURSOR </>] key to make the right field  
flashing.  
•Enter "12". (Note that the number for the right field  
must be equal to or larger than the left field.)  
•Showing the title and "****MB":  
To get enough space for creating a WAV file, the  
specified file on the backup disk will be deleted.  
By pressing the [ENTER/YES] key, "DEL" appears.  
Pressing the [ENTER/YES] key again will delete the  
specified WAV file on the disk and advances to the  
next step (for editing the file name).  
After completing the save operation, the specified WAV  
file will be replaced with the new WAV file on the disk.  
Finally the screen shows "From 05 to 12" to save tracks  
5 through 12.  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
When saving data onto more than one disk, the current  
disk number is shown on the screen as "Disk *" (where  
* indicates the number).  
Immediately after the data save to each disk is  
completed, the disk is automatically ejected, and "Insert  
Disk *" blinks on the screen, prompting you to insert  
the next disk.  
•Showing the title and "-****MB":  
Even if the specified file is deleted, the space for  
creating a new WAV file on the disk is ****MB short.  
Pressing the [ENTER/YES] key shows "Disk Full!",  
followed by "Delete All WAV?".  
Pressing the [ENTER/YES] key again deletes all the WAV  
file on the disk and advances to the next step (for  
editing the file name).  
Inserting the next disk resumes the save operation.  
After completing the save operation, only the new WAV  
file will remain on the disk.  
After the save operation is completed, "Save  
Completed!" appears on the screen.  
After selecting a file, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for editing the WAV file.  
8
<Hint>  
In the save operation which requires more than  
one backup disk, if you use a backup disk which  
contains any program(s) saved, the display shows  
the screen as shown below.  
By rotating the [JOG] dial, you can set the desired  
numeric, symbolic or alphabetical character to the  
blinking point. You can move the blinking point by  
using the [CURSOR] keys.  
See the following table for the available characters.  
Upper-case alphabetical characters (A to Z)  
Numerals (0 to 9)  
Symbols (! # $ % & ' ( ) @ ^ _ -)  
This screen is asking you weather to delete all  
existing WAV files on the disk or to eject the disk.  
To delete all the existing files, select "All Delete" and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key. All existing files are  
deleted and the disk is ready for saving data.  
If you do not want to delete the existing files, select  
"Eject" and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The disk is ejected so you can insert another disk.  
To select between "All Delete" and "Eject", press the  
[CURSOR] key.  
<Note>  
You can use up to 6 characters for a file name.  
Some characters entered are converted as shown  
below.  
• Upper-case alphabetical characters (A to Z): not  
converted  
• Lower-case alphabetical characters (a to z):  
converted to the corresponding upper-case  
• Numerals (0 to 9): not converted  
• Symbols (! # $ % & ' ( ) @ ^ _ -): not converted  
• Other symbols: converted to "_".  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or the [STOP] key)  
repeatedly until exiting the setup mode.  
10  
After entering the file name, press the [ENTER/YES]  
key.  
9
The save operation is executed and the display shows  
something like the one as below. As the file save goes  
on, the remaining data size shown on the screen counts  
down.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
<About WAV files saved>  
•WAV file structure  
A WAV file on the backup disk has 24 files (one file  
per track) in the root directory of the disk.  
The file names are "******01.WAV" through  
"******24.WAV" where "******" shows the file name  
specified in step 8 above and each number (01 - 24)  
shows the corresponding track number.  
If a track has no data recorded, the corresponding file  
with no data is created.  
###### 01. WAV  
###### 02. WAV  
###### 24. WAV  
•WAV file structure which is saved over more than  
one disk  
A WAV file is saved in order of track number (from  
tracks 1 to 24).  
During the save operation over more than one backup  
disk, the VF80 always calculates the available space  
of the disk automatically. If the VF80 knows that the  
available space gets smaller than the data size of the  
next track, it will change the disk when the data save  
of the current track is completed.  
•WAV file size  
When saving data by the WAV file format to a backup  
disk, the file size may sometimes increase compared  
with the data size in the current drive, depending on  
the recorded data condition such as the start time,  
end time, the data amount, etc. on each track.  
For example, if a track is recorded from ABS:0 (min.)  
to ABS:1 (min.) and ABS:10 (min.) to ABS 11 (min.),  
the file on the current drive has a length of 2 minutes,  
while the WAV file has a length of 11 minutes.  
Also as mentioned above, if a track has no data  
recorded, the corresponding WAV file with no data is  
created though the size is small.  
<Notes>  
• If the file name you are going to save duplicates  
with the existing WAV file name on the backup disk,  
"Warning! Already Exist" is shown on the screen and  
the save operation will not be executed.  
In such a case, change the file name according to  
the procedure above and carry out the save  
operation again.  
• A disk on which you have overwritten data many  
times may lower the access speed because of the  
disk fragmentation. Therefore, we suggest that you  
should use a newly formatted "clean" disk for  
backup.  
• If any other file but "******##.WAV" or folder, which  
cannot be recognized by the VF80, is created on the  
backup disk using a personal computer, the VF80  
cannot calculate the available backup disk space  
accurately. Accordingly, it may happen that the save  
operation cannot be completed. You should note this  
when changing the file name or creating a folder  
using your computer.  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Loading a WAV file  
Press the [SETUP] key to enter the setup mode.  
1
The display shows the screen for selecting the Setup  
menu.  
Flashing  
Use the [JOG] dial to select "Load PGM" and press  
2
Flashing  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the device  
from which the data is loaded. "IDE" flashes.  
When the screen shows "Title" and "Size", the selected  
program will be deleted and replaced with the WAV  
file loaded.  
When the screen shows "Title" and "New PGM", the WAV  
file loaded will create a new program.  
While "IDE" is flashing, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
3
The display shows the drive name, followed by the  
screen for selecting the WAV file to be loaded, showing  
the WAV file name and size.  
If no disk is inserted, "No SCSI Disk!" is shown.  
<Note>  
If the current drive does not have enough available  
space for loading the WAV file, the size indication  
on the screen shows a negative value ("-***").  
In such a case, select a program that can be replaced  
with the WAV file loaded without causing the disk  
space shortage, or delete unnecessary programs by  
the "Delete PGM" menu in the setup mode.  
Flashing  
Use the [JOG] dial to select the desired WAV file to  
4
After selecting the load destination program, press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
7
be loaded.  
If more than one WAV file with different file names  
(the first 6 characters) is saved, you can see each file  
name (by the first 6 characters) in order when rotating  
the [JOG] dial. You can also select "Eject" to remove  
the backup disk.  
When selecting a new program as the load destination  
(by selecting an option showing "Title" and "New  
PGM"), the load operation immediately starts.  
When selecting an existing program as the load  
destination (by selecting an option showing "Title" and  
"Size"), "Overwrite?" and "Sure?" appear.  
<Note>  
Pressing the [ENTER/YES] key will start the load  
operation.  
During the load operation, the screen shows something  
like the one as below.  
As the data load goes on, the remaining data size shown  
on the screen counts down.  
The VF80 cannot recognize any other file names  
but "******##.WAV" and cannot load such disks. A  
WAV file with an unique name (the first 6  
characters) is recognized as an independent backup  
file and can be selected.  
After selecting the desired WAV file, press the  
5
[ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting a track to  
be loaded. "All" flashes initially.  
Besides "All", you can select any one of tracks (01  
through 24) by rotating the [JOG] dial (or press the  
[CURSOR] </> key).  
Flashing  
When the load operation is completed, "Load  
Completed!" appears on the screen.  
After selecting the desired track(s), press the [ENTER/  
6
YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the load  
destination program to which a WAV file is loaded.  
You can select the program by using the [JOG] dial.  
<Note>  
The title of the program to which the WAV file is  
loaded is replaced with the WAV file name loaded  
(the first 6 characters).  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or the [STOP] key) repeatedly  
until exiting the setup mode.  
8
To go back to the previous step or abort the operation,  
you can also use the [EXIT/NO] key or the [STOP] key.  
<< Special loading method when using a computer >>  
< Note>  
WAV files which can be saved/loaded by this recorder must have file names written as “******##.WAV.”  
Other file names cannot be acknowledged by this recorder.  
Unknown file names will not be acknowledged and could cause malfunction. Extreme care should be taken when  
changing file names and making folders on a computer.  
* The first six letters will be the title shown in the SETUP mode “Title Edit” display.  
* The last two letters “##” represent each track number (1-24) of the WAV file which are to be saved/loaded.  
* The last “WAV” is the extension which indicate that this is a WAV file.  
* File name of the WAV file which is to be saved in the backup disk of this recorder will all be recorded in capital  
letters. However, in certain computers, this WAV file name will be displayed in small letters.  
(*) Method to load specific tracks.  
The backup disk in which files are saved will contain files from “******01.WAV” up to “******24.WAV.” Should these  
files be deleted, moved from the root directory, for example, into a another folder or the file name changed which  
cannot be acknowledged, this recorder will not recognize this file.  
When a backup disk changed in this manner is loaded, only WAV files with file names “******##.WAV” which are  
located in an acknowledgeable root directory can be loaded.  
For example, if the “zero number of data” made at save is deleted from the backup disk and then load is executed,  
only WAV files recorded with any other sound can be loaded.  
(*) When loading WAV files saved in a multiple number of disks, they can be loaded by a special method  
derived from the above method.  
Assume that there is backup disc 1 saved with “******01.WAV” through “******12.WAV” and disc 2 saved with  
“******13.WAV” through “******24.WAV.”  
First, when backup disk 1 is loaded, files in tracks 1-12 will be loaded. At this point, tracks 13-24 will not be loaded  
and thus be non-recorded. Next, when backup disk 2 is loaded, files in tracks 1-12 remains intact and tracks 13-24  
only will be loaded.  
****** 01. WAV  
****** 12. WAV  
****** 13. WAV  
****** 24. WAV  
Backup Disk 1  
Backup Disk 2  
(*) Method in loading by changing the track.  
If the two letters “##” in file name “******##.WAV” in the backup disk are changed, it will be possible to load them  
on this recorder on a track different from that at the initial save. For example, if a WAV file named “ABCDEF01.WAV”  
on track 1 is changed to “ABCDEF03.WAV” this WAV file will be loaded on track 3.  
(*) Method in loading by changing the title.  
If the 6 letters “******” in file name “******##.WAV” in the backup disk are changed, it will be possible to load them  
on this recorder under a title different from that at the first save. Letters which can be used at changing the file  
name in a computer are those only indicated below. All of these letters must be one byte size.  
Alphabets  
Numerals  
Symbols  
: A-Z and a-z  
: 0-9  
: !#$%&’()@‘_=  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Making an audio CD  
The following procedure describes how to record mastered songs (using the internal mastering function) to a  
CD-RW/CD-R disc to make an audio CD (CD-DA format).  
The “Save PGM” menu in the Setup mode, which is used for saving song data, is also used for making an audio  
CD.  
<Basic information>  
VF80  
When making an audio CD using the VF80, internal  
mastering materials on the current drive are recorded  
to a CD-RW/CD-R disc (by the CD-DA format).  
You can record not only a single song but also mul-  
tiple songs continuously.  
When recording more that one songs continuously,  
the VF80 automatically inserts a 2-second silent space  
between songs.  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
INPUT  
BAL  
B
PHONES  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
CD-RW/CD-R disc  
L
R
MIX  
SCENE  
P
ARAMETER  
SCENE SEQ.  
TRACK  
EDIT  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
F
ADER  
MAP  
P
AN  
EQ  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/FF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
TRACK STATUS  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLA  
Y
MUTE  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS  
/
TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK MASTER  
CURSOR  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
SEL  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
LOCATE  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
DIT  
DIT  
MARK  
DET
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
OCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
<Figure-1>  
<Note>  
Start point  
End point  
Start point  
Start point  
End point  
End point  
If an audio CD is made using a CD-RW disc, it can be  
played back only by a player that supports CD-RW  
playback. You cannot playback such a disc by a con-  
ventional CD player that does not support CD-RW play-  
back.  
3
1
2
Silence (about 2 seconds)  
<Figure-2>  
The following procedure assumes that there is a  
program (song) mastered by the internal master-  
ing function and the optional CD-RW drive (CD-  
1A) is installed to the VF80.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while “SCSI” flashes.  
4
After showing the model name of the connected CD-  
RW drive, the display shows the screen for selecting  
the save mode, in which “BkUp” flashes.  
To carry out making an audio CD, select“CD-DA”.  
If you need to change the copy protection setting (the  
default setting is “OFF”), select “Setup” (for setting  
writing conditions). If you make an audio CD without  
changing the copy protection setting, skip steps 5 and  
6 below and go to step 7.  
<Note>  
Key operations of the VF80 should be done after  
completing access to a CD-RW/CD-R disc.  
After turning on the power of the VF80, load a non-  
1
recorded disc to the CD-RW drive.  
Flashing  
Press the [SETUP] key to enter the Setup mode.  
2
Use the [JOG] dial to select (highlight) theSave PGM”  
3
menu and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the device  
to which the data is saved. “IDE” flashes.  
Use the [JOG] dial (or the [CURSOR]  
/
key) to  
5
select “Setup” and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the “CD-DA Setup” screen, on which  
you can select the copy protection setting (see the next  
page).  
Flashing  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Copy protection setting  
You can restrict the disc copy (duplication) capa-  
bility of an audio CD you are going to make.  
Flashing  
“ON”  
A disc you made can be copied to other digital  
device once.  
“OFF” A disc you made can be copied to other digital  
device as many times as required (default).  
Use the [JOG] dial to select a desired program and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The selected program is set to the first track.  
9
To change the setting, press the [ENTER/YES] key when  
the “CD-DA Setup” screen is shown.  
The current setting starts flashing, showing it can be  
edited. While flashing, use the [JOG] dial to select  
“ON” or “OFF”, then press the [ENTER/YES] key to con-  
firm.  
Flashing  
After setting the copy protection, press the [EXIT/NO]  
key.  
The display returns to the screen for selecting the save  
mode, in which “CD-DA” now flashes.  
6
• To record a single song to a CD-RW/CD-R disc,  
select a program and press the [ENTER/YES] key,  
and then go to step 10.  
• To record more than one song to a CD-RW/CD-R  
disc, repeat the procedure for selecting a program  
described above (i.e. use the [JOG] dial to select a  
program and press the [ENTER/YES] key) until  
selecting all desired programs, and then go to step  
10.  
Flashing  
<Note>  
WhileCD-DAis flashing, press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
After showing “Please Wait!”, the display shows the  
screen for selecting the program(s) to be record.  
In the screen, a number such as “01” or “02” shows the  
track number, while “NON” shows that no program is  
assigned to the track.  
7
If the program time shows “00: 00” when selecting a pro-  
gram as the screen example below, the “Start” and “End”  
points are not correctly set.  
In other words, in the following conditions, the “Start”  
and “End” points are not regarded as being correctly  
set.  
“Start point” = “End point”  
“Start point” > “End point”  
Flashing  
If you press the [ENTER/YES] key after selecting such a  
program, the warning message as below appears on  
the display and you cannot select the program.  
Void In!”,Void Out!”, or “Void Data!”  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key again.  
8
The display shows the screen in which the last pro-  
gram number of the current drive flashes.  
Its program title and recording time are also shown,  
while the total time of songs is shown at the top of the  
screen.  
<Note>  
It is possible to select a program that is not inter-  
nal mastering if it holds the correct “Start” and “End”  
points.  
However, if you record such a program to a CD-  
RW/CD-R disc with the audio CD format, only track  
1 and 2 can be recorded.  
Data between the "Start point" and "End point" is trans-  
ferred to an audio CD.  
Before executing recording, we recommend you to con-  
firm that the actual audio in the program starts just  
after the "Start point" and ends just before "End point".  
So, make sure that you select programs properly  
when making an audio CD.  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
<Hint>  
<Notes for selecting more than one program>  
When recording more than one program to a CD-  
RW/CD-R disc, do not skip any track when assign-  
ing programs to tracks.  
If you skip any track, you cannot record data to the  
subsequent tracks. In the following example, track  
03 is skipped when assigning programs.  
When a CD-RW disc on which any data is recorded  
is set, if you perform step 7 above (i.e. pressing the  
[ENTER/YES] key when “CD-DA” is flashing), “Not  
Empty!” appears on the display, followed by the  
screen for selecting whether erasing recorded data  
or ejecting the disc.  
So only tracks 01 and 02 will be recorded. Tracks  
03 and subsequent tracks can not be recorded.  
<Note>  
Flashing  
When making an audio CD, if you select a program  
which consumes more disc space than the record-  
able space of a CD-RW/CD-R disc, “Disk Full!” ap-  
pears on the display and you cannot select the pro-  
gram.  
Flashing  
• If you erase recorded data:  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key while “ERASE” and  
“Sure?” are flashing.  
After the key press, the display changes as follows  
and the VF80 starts erasing the data.  
As the erasing process is going on, the number of  
flashing “ * ” increases.  
After specifying the program(s), press the [ENTER/  
10  
YES] key while holding down the [RECORD] key.  
The VF80 starts recording to the disc, while the dis-  
play shows the following screen.  
Flashing  
Flashing  
When the recording ends, “Save Completed!” appears  
on the screen, while the disc is automatically ejected  
from the CD-RW drive.  
Increases as the process progresses.  
When completed, press the [EXIT/NO] key to quit the  
Setup mode.  
11  
When erasing is completed, the display shows the  
same screen which appears when pressing the [EN-  
TER/YES] key after selecting “CD-DA” on step 7 above.  
So follow the same procedure from step 8 on page  
116.  
• If you eject the disc:  
Use the [JOG] dial to make “Eject” flashing and then  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The disc is ejected, while “Insert Disk!” appears on  
the screen.  
When inserting a blank disc, you can go on the next  
step (see the procedure described above).  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Loading from an audio CD  
You can load a desired song to the VF80 from an audio CD you created by recording on a CD-RW/CD-R disc.  
When a desired song is loaded, the VF80 automatically creates a new program on the current drive, and the  
song are recorded on tracks 1 and 2 of the program. Loading data from an audio CD is operated via the  
“Load PGM” menu in the Setup mode, which is the same way as loading backup data.  
VF80  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
PHONES  
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
TRACK  
EDIT  
SCENE  
SCENE SEQ.  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
PAN  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
PLAY  
MUTE  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS  
/
TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK MASTER  
CURSOR  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
CD-RW/CD-R disc (or commercially available audio CD)  
<Important note for copyright>  
You can also load a material from a commercially available audio CD in the same manner, however, never use a  
material for which a copyright is reserved for a commercial purpose.  
Any unauthorized use will constitute infringement of such copyright and will render the infringer liable to an  
action at low.  
The following procedure assumes that the optional  
4. Press the [ENTER/YES] key while “IDE” flashes.  
After showing the model name of the connected CD-  
RW drive, the display shows the screen for selecting  
the load mode, in which “BkUp” flashes.  
To carry out loading a song from an audio CD, select  
“CD-DA”.  
4
CD-RW drive (CD-1A) is installed to the VF80 and  
you have an audio CD you created (or available on  
the market).  
<Note>  
Do not carry out any VF80 key operation until the ac-  
cess process to the CD-RW/CD-R disc is completed.  
Flashing  
After turning on the power of the VF80, load a re-  
1
corded audio CD disc to the CD-RW drive.  
Press the [SETUP] key to enter the Setup mode.  
2
Use the [JOG] dial (or [CURSOR]  
(highlight) “CD-DA”, then press the [ENTER/YES]  
key.  
A warning message for copyright appears.  
You can scrolls the message to read all message by  
rotating the [JOG] dial.  
/
key) to select  
5
Use the [JOG] dial to select (highlight) the “Load  
3
PGM” menu and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display shows the screen for selecting the device  
from which the data is loaded. “IDE” flashes.  
Flashing  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
Use the [JOG] dial to select a track number to be  
loaded and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
7
<Warning message>  
The warning message for copyright shown on the  
screen is as follows.  
The destination program number starts flashing,  
which is one greater than the highest program num-  
ber among those available on the current drive.  
This means a track is going to be loaded to a new  
program.  
For example, if there are 4 programs available on  
the current drive, the destination program number(s)  
on the current drive and then perform step 7 above  
again. If there are already 99 programs on the cur-  
rent drive,“Disk Full!” appears and no destination  
program number is shown. In such a case, delete  
the unnecessary program(s) on the current drive and  
then perform step 7 above again.  
Warning!  
You are responsible for use of this digital de-  
vice. Be sure to abide by the copyright condi-  
tions of the source material.  
Press “Enter/Yes” key if you agree with the  
above.  
<Hint>  
The warning message above also appears when  
setting the “Digital In setting” menu to “On”.  
See “Setup mode” on page 130 for details.  
Flashing  
<Note>  
If you do not agree with the warning message con-  
tents, press the [EXIT/NO] key to quit loading.  
The display briefly shows “Set Disable” and “Can’t  
Loading”, then returns to the mode select screen.  
If you agree with the warning message contents,  
go to the next step to continue the operation.  
By rotating the [JOG] dial, you can select “NON”, as  
well as a “Program”. When performing the load op-  
eration, tracks that are set to “NON” are not loaded.  
If you agree to the message contents, press the  
[ENTER/YES] key.  
6
While the program number is flashing, press the  
[ENTER/YES] key.  
8
After showing “Set Enable!”, the display shows the  
screen for selecting the song(s) to be loaded.  
If there is more than one track recorded on the au-  
dio CD, “ ” flashes, showing that you can select a  
desired track. If there is only one track recorded on  
the audio CD. “ ” is not shown on the screen.  
The flashing program number changes to light sol-  
idly, showing that the first track is ready to be loaded  
to the program.  
To load more than one track, repeat steps 7 through  
8 above.  
The following screen example shows that tracks 1  
and 2 will be loaded to program 05 and 06 respec-  
tively. The track time is also shown to the left of  
each program number.  
<When only one track is recorded>  
or  
<Note>  
When loading from a audio CD, no title is shown  
when selecting the track.  
<When more than one track is recorded>  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save/Load of Song data  
<Hint>  
If you are going to load tracks 1 and 3 in the ex-  
ample above, instead of tracks 1 and 2, track 3 will  
be loaded to program 06 (see the screen example  
below).  
However, if you select track 2 after selecting tracks  
1 and 3, the VF80 automatically reassigns track 2  
to program 06 and track 3 to program 07 (see the  
screen example below).  
After specifying track(s) to be loaded, press the  
[ENTER/YES] key while holding down the [RECORD]  
9
key.  
The VF80 starts loading tracks to the current drive.  
The following screen example shows that track 1 is  
now being loaded to program 02 on the current drive.  
When the loading ends, “Load Completed!” appears on  
the screen, while the disc is automatically ejected from  
the CD-RW drive.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key to quit the Setup mode.  
The display returns to the Normal display that was  
shown last time before entering the Setup mode.  
10  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
SETUP mode  
The SETUP mode of the VF80 offers the “Changing the initial settings” menus, which configure the operating  
environment of the VF80, a “Check” menu that enables you to check the number of events for each track, and an  
“Execution” menu that executes certain operations, such as save and load and disk formatting. The “Changing the  
initial settings” menu include 15 parameters as shown in <Table-1> below. These parameters were set before the  
VF80 was shipped from the factory and these values are called the “initial settings.” Modifying these settings allows  
you to change the operating environment of the VF80. The “Check” menu provides two parameters “Checking the  
number of events” as shown in <Table-2> - “Checking the number of events” and “Checking the current drive  
information.”  
Also, as shown in <Table-3>, the “Execution” menus include three items: Load PGM, Save PGM, and Disk Format,  
which you can execute by selecting the corresponding SETUP menu. This chapter explains how to use the “Changing  
the initial settings” menus shown in <Table-1> and the “Check” menu shown in <Table-2>.  
For more information on the “Execution” menus, refer to the corresponding pages in the “Reference page” column  
in <Table-3>.  
<Table-1>Changing the initial settingsmenu  
Parameters  
Display  
Default setting  
Refer page  
122  
Community  
Setting a time signature  
Signature Set  
Tempo Set  
Click  
001BAR 4/4  
Setting a tempo  
001BAR 1 120  
124  
Setting the metronome function  
Setting MIDI sync output signal  
Setting an MTC frame rate  
Setting an MTC offset value  
Setting the offset mode  
Off  
125  
Midi Sync Out  
Frame Rate  
Mtc Offset  
Offset Mode  
Slave Mode  
Slave Type  
Rec Protect  
Digital In  
MTC  
126  
25 frame  
126  
00h 59m 57s 00f 00sf  
127  
ABS  
Off  
Vari  
Off  
Off  
Off  
00  
127  
Setting the slave mode  
128  
Setting the slave type  
128  
Setting the record protect function  
Setting digital input  
129  
130  
Setting BAR/BEAT resolution mode  
Setting the MIDI device ID number  
Setting the fader fix mode  
Setting the fader recall mode  
Resolution  
Device ID  
130  
131  
Fader Fix  
Off  
Off  
132  
Fader Recall  
133  
: Modes applicable program by program. They can be saved/loaded.  
: Modes applicable to all program. They cannot be saved/loaded.  
<Table-2>Checkmenu  
Check item  
Display  
Refer page  
131  
Community  
Check of the event number on the track  
Check of the current drive information  
Number Of Event  
Drive Information  
-
-
132  
<Table-3>Executionmenu  
Execution item  
Display  
Load PGM  
Save PGM  
Disk Format  
Refer page  
Community  
Saving song data to an external device  
Loading song data from an external device  
Formatting an current drive disk  
96  
96  
20  
-
-
-
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
To enter the SETUP mode  
Entering the SETUP is possible only when the VF80 is in the Stop mode.  
While the recorder is stopped, press the [SETUP] key on  
1
<Note>  
the operating panel.  
At shipping from the plant or when power is switched  
on again, the “Signature Set” menu will be reversed in  
white-black. Otherwise, when exiting from the SETUP  
mode, the SETUP menu that was displayed last will be  
reversed in black and white.  
When the [SETUP] key is pressed, the recorder enters the  
SETUP mode first stage and change to the display for  
selecting the SETUP menu. The white black reversed title  
indicates the currently selected menu and the (flash)  
indicates that other titles exist below.  
If the desired menu is selected via the [JOG] dial and the  
[ENTER/YES] key pressed,you can proceed to the actual  
setup procedure.  
2
<Important>  
* To exit from the SETUP mode or return to the previous  
level, press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key).  
* When selecting the desired SETUP menu, the  
[CURSOR  
/
] keys can be used in addition to the  
[JOG] dial.  
Time signature setting [“Signature Set”]  
Using the “Setting a time signature” menu, you can set a time signature of a given measure on the internal  
programmable Tempo Map. Also in this setting, the BAR (-002BAR, 1 , 00CLK) displayed at the head of the  
disk in the time base BAR/BEAT/CLK can be set within a range of -009BAR ~ -002BAR.  
For example, you can specify 4/4 for the first and second measures, and 2/2 from the third measure.”  
Setting a time signature and tempo will create a Tempo Map, which allows the VF80 to manage a song using  
the BAR/BEAT/CLK Time Base. You can also use the Metronome function.  
A time signature and tempo setting are required when MIDI clock & song position pointer are output to an  
external sequencer.  
• New Registering ofTime Signature  
* Initial Setting  
* Available bars  
* Available time signature  
:
:
:
001bar 4/4 beat  
001 ~ 999  
1/4, 2/4, 3/4, 4/4, 5/4, 1/8,  
3/8, 5/8, 6/8, 7/8, 8/8, DEL  
64  
While in the previous step 2 display, select “Insert  
3
New Event” and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The “Insert New Event” display section will change to  
the display for setting up a new bar and the “002”  
numberwill flash.  
* Maximum setting points  
* The setting is applicable song by song.  
* The setting can be saved or loaded as a part of the song data  
* The setting is memorized even when the power is off.  
* Make sure you choose the right program before setting this  
mode.  
:
At this point, the bar figure displayed will be the bar  
figure setup last +1 and the signature figure displayed  
will be same as the last setting (Example: In the initial  
state,002BAR 4/4 ” will be shown.  
Select a program for which to set a time signature.  
In the menu selecting display, selectSignature Setand  
1
2
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display will change to confirming the currently set  
signature. In the initial setting, the display will be as  
shown below to indicate that the bar offset is -002BAR,  
signature from the first bar is set to 4/4, and nothing is  
set after the first bar.  
flashing  
If the [JOG] dial is rotated, items displayed can be  
alternately selected. -002BAR Offset” to setup the bar  
offset figure, “Insert New Event” to setup a new signature  
following the first bar, and “All Clear” to clear all signature/  
tempo settings, can be selected.  
Input the desired bar figure with the [JOG] dial and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
It will change to flashing of “4/4 .”  
4
5
Input the desired meter via the [JOG] dial and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The input bar and signature figures will be set as shown  
in the following. This display is an example of setting  
the third bar to 3/4 beat. If the [JOG] dial is rotated,  
the editing point of bar or signature, like the figures  
shown below, can be input.  
flashing  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The selected measure/signature setting will be deleted.  
3
4
After deleting, press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key)  
to exit from the SETUP mode.  
flashing  
<Note>  
You cannot register the “001BAR“ of “001BAR 4/4 .”  
The following bar numbers and time signatures can be  
entered via the [JOG] dial.  
<Note>  
Take care because this procedure wipes out the tempo  
setting as well as time signature setting.  
Bar  
You can enter are from 001 to 999.  
Time  
1/4, 2/4, 3/4, 4/4, 5/4, 1/8, 3/8, 5/8, 6/8, 7/8, 8/8  
Signature or DEL  
“DELis used to deleted time signature data.  
• Clearing AllTime Signature/Tempo Data  
Next, to register other bar and time signature, repeat  
steps 2 through 5.  
<Note>  
6
7
Be careful because this procedure wipes out the tempo  
setting as well as time signature setting.  
Upon completion of registering, press the [EXIT/NO]  
key (or the [STOP] key) and exit from the SETUP mode.  
Under the above “Confirmation display,select “All  
1
Clear” and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
A following display of “All Clear,” “SURE ?” will flash.  
This indicates the standby mode for clearing all  
signature setting data and the tempo data.  
• Correcting the RegisteredTime Signature  
Under the previousConfirmation display,select bar/  
1
time signatures to be changed and press the [ENTER/  
YES] key.  
Input the desired signature via the [JOG] dial and  
2
flashing  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The newly input signature will be setup.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
2
Time  
Signature or DEL  
“DELis used to deleted time signature data.  
1/4, 2/4, 3/4, 4/4, 5/4, 1/8, 3/8, 5/8, 6/8, 7/8, 8/8  
Except for the initial setting “001BAR 4/4 ,” other time  
signature settings and the tempo setting will be cleared  
at the same time.  
Upon finishing, press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP]  
key) to exit from the SETUP mode.  
3
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
3
the SETUP mode.  
• Changing the Bar Offset Figure  
• Deleting aTime Signature  
Under the above “Confirmation display,select  
1
Under the above “Confirmation display,select bar/  
1
“-002BAR Offset” and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
time signatures to be deleted and press the [ENTER/  
YES] key.  
The “-002” display will change to flashing.  
Press the [ENTER/YES] key again to make “ */* ” to  
2
flashing  
flash and input “DELvia the [JOG] dial.  
flashing  
Input the desired offset value with the [JOG] dial and  
2
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
Offset value can be input in the -2 through -9 range.  
After correction, press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP]  
3
key) to exit from the SETUP mode.  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
Setting a tempo [“Tempo Set”]  
The “Tempo Map Set” menu enables you to specify a tempo at a given point in a song that already has a time  
signature setting. For example, you can specify a tempo of 150 to the third beat of the 12th measure.  
Time signature and tempo settings make a Tempo Map, which is used by the VF80 to manage the song using the  
BAR/BEAT/CLK time base, and enable the metronome function. Tempo settings as well as time signature settings  
are required when you wish to output MIDI clock and Song Position Pointer to an external sequencer.  
<Note>  
The tempo set figure setup here is an approximate figure and thus not accurate. Therefore, although the tempo map be  
matched with a personal computer, they will gradually drift apart. In order to prevent this drift, the personal computer  
side can be set to either MIDI clock sync or, the MIDI sync output signal temporarily set to “MIDI Clock” the figure reset  
to make it possible for the computer to read the accurate tempo, and the return it again to MTC sync.  
Input the desired bar with the [JOG] dial and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The bar value that can be input is identical with the  
above “signature setup.” When the [ENTER/YES] key is  
pressed, “beat value” will change to flashing.  
* Initial Setting: 001BAR 1st beat 120 bpm  
* Bar to register: Follows to the time signature setting  
* Beat to register: Follows to the time signature setting  
* Available tempo: 30 ~ 250, DEL (delete)  
* Maximum setting points:64  
* The setting is applicable song by song.  
* The setting can be saved or loaded as a part of the  
song data  
2
Input the desired beat with the [JOG] dial and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The meter value that can be input is identical with the  
above “signature setup.” When the [ENTER/YES] key is  
pressed, “tempo value” will change to flashing.  
3
4
* The setting is memorized even when the power is off.  
* Make sure you choose the right program before setting  
this mode.  
Select a program for which to set a tempo setting.  
1
2
Input the desired tempo with the [JOG] dial and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The tempo can be input within the range of 30 through  
250. When the [ENTER/YES] key is pressed, the tempo  
map value thus input will be set and return to the  
above mentioned “Confirmation display for tempo  
map.”  
Under the menu selection display, selectTempo Set”  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The display will change, confirming the current tempo  
setting. At the initial setting, the display will be as  
shown below, indicating that tempo of the first beat  
for the 001 bar is 120 and subsequent tempo is not  
setup. “Insert New Event” should be selected at setup  
of a new tempo. When the [JOG] dial is rotated, the  
currently displayed items can be selected alternately.  
To register another tempo map, repeat steps 1 through  
4.  
5
6
Upon completing registering, press the [EXIT/NO] key  
(or [STOP] key) to exit from the SETUP mode.  
For a setup example, if it is attempted to setup the  
following tempo in the music that is set to [001BAR 4/  
4 ] and [005BAR 3/4 ] by the previous “signature  
setup,” as seen in the music score below, the tempo  
flashing  
• New Registering ofTempo  
4
4
Under the aboveConfirmation display,selectInsert  
New Event” and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
1
Tempo = 120  
Tempo = 90  
The “Insert New Event” section will change to new tempo  
setup display and “002” will flash. The bar value thus  
displayed will be the last setup bar value +1 and tempo  
value will be identical with the last setting (Example:  
3
4
In the initial setup state, “002BAR 1  
displayed.  
=120” will be  
Tempo = 60  
Tempo = 120  
Tempo Map  
Tempo setting  
001 BAR 1 = 120  
Time signature setting  
flashing  
001 BAR 4/4  
003 BAR 1  
= 90  
005 BAR 3  
007 BAR 2  
= 60  
005 BAR 3/4  
= 120  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
• Correction of the RegisteredTempo  
• Erasing of the RegisteredTempo  
Under the above “Confirmation display,select the  
tempo map which is to be erased and press the  
[ENTER/YES] key.  
Under the above “Confirmation display,select the  
1
1
tempo map which is to be changed and press the  
[ENTER/YES] key.  
The same as before, “tempo value” will flash.  
The same as before, “tempo value” will flash.  
Input the desired tempo with the [JOG] dial and press  
2
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
flashing  
Upon completing registering, press the [EXIT/NO] key  
3
(or [STOP] key) to exit from the SETUP mode.  
Input the “DELwith the [CURSOR ] key, and then  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The selected tempo map will be erased.  
2
3
Upon completing registering, press the [EXIT/NO] key  
(or [STOP] key) to exit from the SETUP mode.  
<Note>  
You cannot register the “001BAR 1  
=120.”  
Setting the Metronome function [“Click”]  
“Setting the Metronome function” menu allows you to determine whether or not the VF80 outputs a metronome  
sound from track 6 during playback or recording. Turning the Metronome function on enables you to record your  
performance while playing the instrument accompanying the metronome sound.  
<Note>  
Metronome sound will be output from track 6.  
For this reason, when the metronome function is activated, a new sound source cannot be recorded on the  
track to which the metronome sound is to be output or sound recorded on this track cannot be played back.  
If the metronome function is not to be used, be sure to reset it to “Off.”  
* Initial Setting  
* Available setting  
* The setting is applicable song by song.  
* The setting can be saved or loaded as a part of the song data  
* The setting is memorized even when the power is off.  
* Make sure you choose the right program before setting this  
mode.  
:
:
[Off]  
[Off] or [On]  
Select “On” or “Off” with the [JOG] dial and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The selected item will be setup.  
2
On  
Metronome sound will be output from  
track 6.  
Off (default)  
Metronome sound will not be output.  
SelectClickin the menu selection display and press  
1
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The currently set item (Off or On) will flash (“Off” will  
flash if in the initial state).  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
3
flashing  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
Setting MIDI sync output signal [“Midi Sync Out”]  
The “Setting MIDI sync output signal” menu enables you to select the type of MIDI sync signals output from  
the MIDI OUT connector on the rear panel of the VF80 to an external MIDI device.  
The options are MIDI clock & Song Position Pointer, or MTC (MIDI time code). Select an appropriate option  
depending on the type of signal supported by the connected MIDI device.  
If you select MIDI clock & Song Position Pointer, first you need to set the time signatures and tempo as  
described previously. If you select MTC, you first need to set the MTC frame rate, the MTC offset time, and the  
MTC offset mode as described later.  
Select the desired MIDI sync signal with the [JOG]  
dial and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
• Initial setting: [Mtc]  
• Option: [CLK] (clock & Song Position Pointer),  
[MTC] (MIDI time code), or [Off] (no  
output)  
* You can set the parameters for each Program  
individually.  
2
CLK (Initial setting)  
MIDI clock and song position  
pointer will be output.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
Mtc  
Off  
MIDI time code will be output.  
Any MIDI sync signal will not  
be output.  
Select “Midi Sync Out” in the menu selection display  
1
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The currently set item will flash. CLK” will flash in  
initial setting.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
3
flashing  
Setting an MTC frame rate [“Frame Rate”]  
The “Setting an MTC frame rate” menu enables you to set the frame rate for MTC output from the MIDI OUT  
connector of the VF80 to an external MIDI device. If you have already set the type of MIDI sync output signal  
to [MTC], you need to set the frame rate. Use the frame rate of MTC received by the external MIDI device (or  
sequence software).  
Select the desired frame rate value with the [JOG]  
dial and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
It will be set to the selected frame rate.  
• Initial setting:  
• Setting range of frame rate: [24], [25], [29df],  
[29nd], [30df] or [30nd]  
* You can set the value for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
[25] (25 frames)  
2
3
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
<Note>  
SelectFrame Ratein the menu selection display and  
1
There are no 29.97nd or 29.97df in the MTC standard.  
Use either 30nd or 30df unless you definitely need to  
synchronize the VF80 with NTSC video.  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The currently set frame rate will flashes. 25” will flash  
in the initial setting.  
flashing  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
Setting an MTC offset value [“Mtc Offset Set”]  
The “Setting an MTC offset value” menu enables you to specify an offset time value - the difference between  
the time of MTC output from the VF80 and the ABS 00m 00s 00f 00sf time. You need to specify this value if  
you have selected [MTC] for the “Setting MIDI sync output signal” menu.  
With the initial setting of 00h 59m 57s 00f 00sf, for example, MTC of 59m 57s 00f 00sf is output at the ABS  
time 00m 00s 00f 00sf. You can also set an offset value from the 001bar 1beat 00clk value (bar/beat) on the  
Tempo Map. Refer to the next section for information on MTC Offset mode.  
• Initial setting:  
[00h: 59m: 57s: 00f: 00sf]  
• Setting range of offset time: 00h: 00m: 00s: 00f: 00sf  
~ 23h: 59m: 59s: 29f: 99sf  
* You can set the value for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
flashing  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
<Note>  
For example, if you set MTC Offset mode to “ABS” (See the  
next section) and you wish to start the song from MTC’s  
01h 00m 00s 00f, you may wish to set a preroll of three  
seconds with an MTC offset of 00h 59m 57s 00f.  
Move the edit point with the [CURSOR] key, input the  
desired offset with the [JOG] dial, then press the  
[ENTER/YES] key.  
Offset value thus input will be set.  
Advancing or retarding the input figure is carried out  
automatically with reference to the currently set MTC  
frame rate figure.  
2
3
Select “Mtc Offset Set” in the menu selection display  
1
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
It will change to the second level display of the [Mtc  
Offset] menu and the currently set offset value will be  
shown.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
00h 59m 00f 00sf will be displayed in the initial state  
and “s” will flash. Flashing indicates the editable point.  
Setting MTC Offset mode [“Offset Mode”]  
If you have selected [MTC] in the “Setting Offset mode” menu, you need to select MTC Offset mode.  
This menu enables you to determine whether the specified MTC is output at ABS 00h 00m 00s 00f or at  
001bar 1beat 00clk (bar/beat) of the Tempo Map.  
<Notes>  
* As an example, if you set MTC Offset mode to “ABS” and you wish to start the song from MTC’s 1h 00m 00s 00f, you  
may want to set a preroll of three seconds with MTC offset of 00h 59m 57s 00f.  
If you select “Bar “ as the MTC Offset mode, a preroll of two measures is automatically set. Use 01h 00m 00s 00f; do  
not set a preroll value.  
* If you set Offset mode to “Bar “ and use MTC to synchronize sequence software on the computer, the tempo of the  
sequencer may sometimes slip gradually. This is because the tempo of the VF80 and the tempo of the software are  
slightly different even if both use the same tempo. Some sequence software can read the tempo output from the VF80  
correctly. We recommend that you use the tempo of the VF80 on the sequence software. No such problems will  
occur if the sequence software synchronizes the VF80 via MIDI clock, instead of MTC.  
• Initial setting:  
[ABS]  
• Offset mode option:  
[ABS] or [Bar ]  
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
flashing  
Select “Offset Mode” in the menu selection display  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
1
The currently set offset mode will flash. ABS” will  
flash in the initial setting.  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
Select the desired offset mode with the [JOG] dial  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
2
3
The selected offset mode will be set.  
[ABS] (Initial setting)  
[BAR ]  
The specified MTC offset time is  
output at ABS 00h 00m 00s 00f.  
The specified MTC offset time is  
output at 001bar 1beat 00clk of  
theTempo Map.  
Setting the Slave mode [“Slave Mode”]  
This mode allows you to choose the VF80 slave mode setting either On or Off.  
If you set the slave mode to “On”, the VF80 will synchronize to the incoming MTC (MIDI Time Code) from  
master unit. It will also synchronize to a type of external sync signal which you have chosen with the section  
“Slave Type setting.”  
SelectOn” orOff” with the [JOG] dial and press the  
[ENTER/YES] key.  
• Initial setting:  
• Slave mode option:  
[Off]  
[On] or [Off]  
2
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
Upon exit from the SETUP mode, the “SLAVE” icon  
will flash.  
3
SelectSlave Modein the menu selection display and  
1
This icon will change to constant lighting when VF80  
is correctly synchronized with the external equipment.  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The currently set slave mode will flash. Off” will flash  
in the initial setting.  
flashing  
flashing  
Setting the SlaveType [“SlaveType”]  
If you have set Slave Mode to “On” in the previous section “Slave Mode Setting,” you can choose what type of  
external sync signal that the VF80 synchronizes to. This mode allows you to choose the external sync signal type.  
• Initial setting:  
[Vari]  
<Notes>  
• Slave type option: [Vari], [Free] or [SPDIF]  
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
* You need to input MTC from an external device to the  
VF80 with any Slave Type.  
* The VF80 re-chase window is fixed to ten frames. That  
is, if an offset between the master device and slave device  
exceeds ten frames, the VF80 interprets that as out of  
sync, and tried to chase and lock to MTC sent from the  
master device. This operation is called “re-chasing.”  
During the re-chase operation, audio output is muted.  
If the slave machine slips with MTC from the master  
device by less than ten frames, the slave machine  
continues running while recognizing the slippage.  
* When you set the Slave Type, the Vari Pitch function is  
automatically disabled. (The “VARI PITCH” indicator  
turns off.)  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
SelectSlaveTypein the menu selection display and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The currently set slave type will flash. Vari” will be  
flash in the initial setting.  
1
This is the mode whereby after chase  
locking, it will free run by the internal  
clock of VF80 or the digital in clock  
from the external equipment should  
the time drift away from that of the  
master.  
Free  
This is the mode whereby after chase  
locking, it will constantly run by vari-  
pitch so that the time does not drift  
away from that of the master by  
compensating the phase drift.  
Vari  
(Initial setting)  
flashing  
However, if digital in has been set, it  
will operate the same as for “Free.”  
This is the mode whereby after chase  
locking, it will free run by the S/P DIF  
clock only when there is S/P DIF digital  
signals from the master.  
However, if digital in has been set, that  
clock will have priority.  
Select the desired slave type with the [JOG] dial and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
It will be set to the selected slave type.  
2
SPDIF  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
3
Setting the Record Protect function [“Rec Protect”]  
The “Setting the Record Protect function” menu allows you to turn the Record Protection function On or Off.  
When this function in turned “On”, you cannot record, paste, or erase data. Use this function to protect your  
important data from being accidentally erased.  
• Initial setting:  
• Options:  
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
[Off]  
[On] or [Off]  
<Note>  
When recording is disabled (“On”) and you try to record,  
paste, or erase data, the VF80 displays “Protected!” for a  
second, indicating that you cannot perform the operation.  
To perform the operation you need to enable recording  
(“Off”).  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
Select “Rec Protect” in the menu selection display  
1
and then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The presently set item (On or Off) will flash.  
“Off” will flash in the initial setting.  
flashing  
SelectOnorOffwith the [JOG] dial and then press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
It will be set to the selected item (On or Off).  
2
3
Selecting “Off” enables recording; you can record,  
paste, and erase data.  
Selecting “On” disables recording; and you cannot  
record, paste, or erase data.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
Setting Digital Input [“Digital In”]  
In the [Setting digital input] menu, whether the signal assigned to tracks 7 and 8 are S/P DIF digital signal  
analog signals, can be setup. By using this function, it becomes possible to digitally record from external  
digital equipment (CD, MD, DAT, adat, digital mixer, etc.).  
You can scroll the message by rotating the [JOG] dial.  
• Initial setting: [Off]  
If you agree to the message, press the [ENTER/YES] key  
again. If you do not agree to the message, press the  
[EXIT/NO] key to stop setting.  
• Options:  
[On] or [Off]  
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings cannot be saved and loaded as part of  
the song data.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
3
Select “Digital In” in the menu selection display and  
then press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
<Note>  
1
When setting “Digital In” to “On”, “DIGI IN” appears on  
the Normal screen. While the VF80 receives a valid S/P  
DIF digital signal from an external digital device and is  
locked to it, “DIGI IN” steadily lights. While the VF80 does  
not receive a valid S/P DIF signal, “DIGI IN” blinks.  
If “DIGI IN” blinks when sending an S/P DIF signal from  
the external device, check the connection between the VF80  
and the external device, as well as the settings (for the  
digital output, etc) of the external device.  
The presently set item (On or Off) will flash.  
Off” will flash in the initial setting.  
flashing  
<Note>  
When “Digital In” is set to “On”, if you enter the bounce,  
training or mastering mode, the “Digital In” setting is  
automatically changes to “Off.” Therefore, to perform the  
digital recording after exiting the move above, you must  
set “Digital In” to “On” again.  
SelectOnorOffwith the [JOG] dial and then press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
It will be set to the selected item (On or Off).  
When selecting “On” and pressing the [ENTER/YES]  
key, “Warning” message appears.  
2
Setting BAR/BEAT Resolution mode [“Resolution”]  
The “Setting BAR/BEAT resolution mode” menu enables you to turn BAR/BEAT resolution mode on and off.  
The initial setting is “Off.” When you turn this mode “On”, the CLK (clock) digits will be always round off to “00”  
and be stored in the memory key while the VF80 is using the BAR/BEAT/CLK time base.  
That is, beat-resolution is used. Using this function allows you to automatically store a beat-resolution value of the  
IN/OUT points, START/END points and END point in real-time. Therefore, it is very convenient when you perform  
the Copy & Paste or Move & Paste operation in beat-resolution.  
SelectResolutionin the menu selection display and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The presently set item will be flash (On or Off).  
Off” will flash in the initial setup.  
For example, assume that you have stored the value for  
001bar 1 46 clk as the START point, and the value for  
002bar 4 51 clk as the END point.  
These values will be used as they are if BAR/BEAT  
resolution mode is turned off. However, the mode is  
turned on, the following values will be stored instead.  
The following example has a time signature setting of 4/  
4.  
1
001 bar 1 46 clk -> 001 bar 1 00 clk  
(A clk value of 46 will be rounded off.)  
002 bar 4 51 clk -> 003 bar 1 00 clk  
(A clk value of 51 will be rounded up.)  
flashing  
• Initial setting:  
• Options:  
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings cannot be saved and loaded as part of  
the song data.  
[Off]  
[On] or [Off]  
Select “On” or “Off” with the [JOG] dial and press the  
[ENTER/YES] key.  
2
3
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
Setting the MIDI device number [“Device ID”]  
The “Setting the MIDI device number” menu enables you to set the VF80 device ID number required to control the  
VF80 from a sequence software using MMC (MIDI Machine Control).  
The transmit device ID links to this setting. You can set the device ID from 00 to 99.  
However, if the device ID number of the message the VF80 receives is [7F], the VF80 will recognizes it to perform the  
corresponding operation, regardless of its device ID setting.  
Select desired device number with the [JOG] dial and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
• Initial setting:  
• Options:  
* You can set the mode for each Program individually.  
* The settings cannot be saved and loaded as part of  
the song data.  
[00]  
[00] ~ [99]  
2
3
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or STOP key) to exit from  
the SETUP mode.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
Select “Device ID” in the menu selection display and  
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
1
The presently device number will be flash.  
00” will flash in the initial setup.  
flashing  
Checking the number of track events [“Number Of Event”]  
The “Checking the number of track events” menu enables you to check the number of events on each track.  
Each track (including Additional tracks) of VF80 Programs consists of consecutive audio files (and “zero”  
files). The number of events represents the total number of audio files and 0 files. Each track can contain up  
to 512 events.  
If you are editing a song of typical length (about six minutes), repeated editing operation does not usually  
exceed this maximum number. (Exceeding this limit is called “event number overflow.”) Even a 20-minute  
song will not cause event number overflow. This is because the recorder system always optimizes the data  
structure by keeping the number of events low. However, if a recording on a track is scattered in different  
areas of the disk, or if you have made a very long recording on a single track and performed many edits, you  
should be wary of “event number overflow.” To avoid this problem, use the “Checking the number of track  
events” menu to check the number of events on each track prior to recording or editing.  
SelectNumber of Eventin the menu a selection display  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
It will change to the "Event" second level and the  
event number currently in each track will be dis-  
played (The * symbol indicates there is data below).  
*** is the event number.  
Use the [JOG] dial to select another (01~24) to check  
the number of events on the corresponding track.  
1
2
3
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key) to exit from the  
SETUP mode.  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
The Drive Format Information [“Drive Information”]  
Format information of the current drive currently installed can be checked by using the “Drive Format  
Information” menu. Should any trouble occur in the VF80, providing the information obtained here to our  
nearest Fostex Service Station will be of great help in giving quick service.  
The following items will be displayed and can be confirmed.  
SelectDrive Informationin the menu selection display  
1
1. Manufacture / Model of the currently installed hard  
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
disk.  
It will change to the "Drive Information" second level  
and the current drive information currently in use  
2. Format method  
3. Format type  
will be displayed (The symbol indicates there is data  
below).  
4. Simultaneously recordable number of tracks  
5. Number of bits at formatting  
6. Sampling frequency at formatting  
7. Present number of programs  
8. Present number of free blocks  
9. Audio file / maximum number of events and its  
program No.  
10. Specific capacity of the drive  
11. Remaining capacity of the drive  
12. Present software version  
As the [JOG] dial is rotated,information will be displayed  
one by one.  
2
3
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key) to exit from the  
SETUP mode.  
Fader Fix Mode Setting [“Fader Fix”]  
Whether the fader manipulation should be reflected on the sound volume or not can be set.  
The setup content will be held even if the main power is switched off.  
Select the desired item with the [JOG] dial and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The selected item will be set.  
2
<Caution>  
The “Fader Fix Mode” can be made to function when set  
in other (Track, Master or Trk & Mst) than “Off” of the  
next item on the “Fader Recall Mode”.  
On  
For all modes, manipulation of the  
Track fader/Master fader will  
have not affect on the sound volume.  
Any accidental shifting of the fader  
position by vibration and  
• Initial setting:  
• Options:  
* You can set the value for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
[Off]  
[On] or [Off]  
misoperation can be prevented.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
Off (Initial setting) Manipulation of the Track fader/  
Master fader will affect the sound  
volume.  
Select “Fader Fix” in the menu selection display and  
1
press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The currently set will flash. Off” will flash in the initial  
setting.  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key) to exit from the  
SETUP mode.  
3
flashing  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP mode  
Fader Recall Mode Setting [“Fader Recall”]  
In the "Setup of the fader recall mode" menu, whether each track fader/master fader settings should be  
recalled or not at scene recall, can be setup.  
Input the desired item with the [JOG] dial and press  
the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The selected item will be set.  
2
• Initial setting: [Off]  
• Options:  
[Off], [Track], [Master] or [Trk & Mst]  
* You can set the value for each Program individually.  
* The settings can be saved and loaded as part of the  
song data.  
* The settings are maintained after you turn off the  
power to the VF80.  
Off  
When scene is recalled, the fader  
(Initial setting)  
position immediately prior to  
recalling the scene will be directly  
employed without recalling the  
setup figures of each track fader and  
the master fader.  
Select “Fader Recall” in the menu a selection display  
1
and press the [ENTER/YES] key.  
The currently set will flash. Off” will flash in the  
initial setting.  
Track  
When scene is recalled, setup figures  
of each track faders only will be  
recalled and not recall the master  
fader setup figure.  
Master  
Trk & Mst  
When scene is recalled, the setup  
figure of the master fader only is  
recalled and the track fader setup  
figures will not be recalled.  
When scene is recalled, each track  
faders and the master fader set up  
figures will both be recalled.  
flashing  
Press the [EXIT/NO] key (or [STOP] key) to exit from the  
SETUP mode.  
3
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix (Installing the optional CD-RW drive)  
Installing the CD-1A  
The CD-1A package includes the drive and accessories shown below.  
After purchasing the unit, check that all items are included. When installing the CD-1A to the VF80, the blank  
panel and two screws are not used.  
*a CD-RW drive unit  
*two screws for mounting the drive  
*a blank panel  
<Usable discs>  
<Notes on handling of discs>  
With the CD-1A, you can use discs of following  
• When handling a disc, be careful not to dirty or  
types.  
scratch the surface of the disc.  
We recommend that you hold the disc with your  
finger on the disc edge and center hole.  
<CD-R discs>  
Can be used for saving or loading song  
data, as well as making an audio CD.  
Note that you can record data to a CD-  
R disc only once. You cannot record  
Recordable  
data to a disc which has been recorded  
before.  
• Do not stick any paper, etc. on the label side.  
<CD-RW discs>  
Also do not scratch the label side, which may cause  
problems during playback or recording. Use only a  
felt pen or equivalent for writing any memo on the  
label side. Using a ball-point pen, pencil, etc. that  
has a hard tip may damage a disc.  
Can be used for saving or loading song  
data, as well as making an audio CD.  
You can record or erase data to a CD-  
R disc as many times as wish.  
ReWritable  
<Audio CD discs>  
As these are read-only discs, you only  
can use them for loading track data  
to the VF80.  
• Never use a warped or chipped disc, which may  
damage the CD-RW drive.  
<Notes on care of disc>  
• If there is a dust, dirt or fingerprints on the disc, which  
may cause error in playback or recording, wipe the  
disc with a soft, dry cloth or alcohol from the center  
out. Never wipe from the outside to center.  
• Do not use a cleaner for analog discs or antistatic  
spray, as well as volatile solvents such as benzine,  
which may damage the disc surface.  
• Do not expose any disc to direct sunlight, or leave it  
in hot, moist or cold places.  
• Read the attached manual packed with the disc be  
fore using it.  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix (Installing the optional CD-RW drive)  
How to install the CD-1A  
<Notes on installing the CD-RW drive>  
The CD-RW drive is made of precision parts.  
Do not apply a mechanical shock or use excessive force when installing it.  
Before installing the drive, make sure that the power of the VF80 is off and the power cord is  
disconnected.  
Install the drive correctly according to this manual.  
Note that damage to the drive caused by inappropriate installation is not covered by the  
guarantee.  
Remove the side cover of the VF80 by unfastening  
the two screws using a screw driver.  
After removing the cover, remove the blank panel  
attached inside the cover.  
Insert the CD-1A unit to the VF80 as shown below.  
Carefully insert the CD-1A to the VF80 in the right  
direction, without rubbing it against the VF80 cabi-  
net. Push the unit carefully and firmly with your  
both hands, but without excessive force, until you  
feel the connector of the CD-1A mesh with the inter-  
nal connector.  
1
3
Retain the cover which will be used later.  
Connector  
Cover  
Insert the CD-1A  
Using the screw (1 pc.) which tightened the blank  
panel to VF80, fix CD-1A to the VF80 chassis.  
Fasten the screws without excessive force.  
4
Blank panel  
Remove the metal fitting by unfastening the retain-  
2
ing screw (indicated by an arrow) inside the CD-1A.  
Because the screw head is small, use a micro screw  
driver to carefully unfasten the screw without dam-  
aging the head by excessive force.  
CD-1A  
Fix the cover removed in step 1.  
5
6
Connect the power cable of theVF80 to an AC main  
outlet, and turn on the power.  
Check that the VF80 starts up and the indicator on  
the front panel of the CD-1A flashes for a few sec-  
onds and then turns off.  
Do not operate the CD-1A unit the VF80 display  
shows the Normal screen after showing the start-up  
screen.  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix (Installing the optional CD-RW drive)  
Opening/closing the tray  
Placing/removing a disc  
The following are some notes on placing and/or re-  
moving a disc.  
• To open the tray, press the eject switch lightly.  
Pressing the switch will open the tray slightly.  
Then pull out the tray gently by hand to fully open it.  
<IMPORTANT!>  
When placing a disc on the tray, support the tray from  
the bottom by your hand. If you push the disc to fit  
into the pivot on the tray without supporting the tray,  
the tray/drive may be damaged or broken. Also note  
that the disc must be pushed until it clicks so that it is  
locked into the pivot securely. Closing the tray without  
locking the disc may damage the disc.  
<Note for removing a disc from the tray>  
When removing a disc from the tray, also support the  
tray from the bottom by your hand. Also be careful  
not to unlock the disc from the pivot forcibly, which  
may damage the tray.  
Eject  
• Place the disc with the label side up.  
When placing the disc, support the tray from the bottom  
by your hand as shown in the illustration below, and push  
the disc gently until it clicks so that the disc is locked into  
the pivot.  
Lens  
<Caution!>  
Do not touch the lens when pulling out  
the tray, doing so may damage it and may  
cause a malfunction.  
Support the tray from the bottom.  
<Caution!>  
To close the tray, push the tray inside by hand until locked.  
Do not touch the lens when placing a disc,  
doing so may damaged may cause a mal-  
function.  
Push  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
(Digital Multitracker)  
Model VF80  
Date:  
Version: V1.00  
MIDI Implementation Chart  
Transmitted  
Recognized  
Remarks  
Function....................  
X
X
X
X
Basic  
Default  
Channel  
Changed  
X
X
X
X
X
Default  
Message  
Altered  
Mode  
********************************  
X
X
Note  
X
True Voice  
Number:  
********************************  
X
X
X
X
Velocity  
Note ON  
Note OFF  
X
X
After  
X
X
Key’s  
Channel’s  
Touch  
Pitch Bend  
X
X
X
X
Control  
Change  
X
X
Program  
Change  
X
True #  
********************************  
System Exclusive  
(rem. 1)  
(rem. 2)  
: Quarter Frame  
X
X
X
: Song Position  
: Song Select  
: Tune  
Common  
X
X
X
X
: Clock  
System  
Real Time : Commands  
(rem. 3)  
X
X
X
: Local ON/OFF  
: All Notes OFF  
X
X
X
Aux.  
: Active Sense  
Message  
X
: Reset  
X
rem.1: MMC (Device ID=00~99, 127), MTC, Identity reply  
rem.2: MMC (Device ID=00~99, 127), MTC, Inquiry  
Notes  
rem.3: START, STOP, CONTINUE  
Mode 1: OMNI ON, POLY  
Mode 3: OMNI OFF, POLY  
Mode 2: OMNI ON, MONO  
Mode 4: OMNI OFF, MONO  
: Yes  
X: No  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
MMC Command List  
Command list  
STOP  
Movement (Recorder)  
01: STOP  
02: PLAY  
PLAY  
03: DEFERRED PLAY  
04: FAST FORWARD  
05: REWIND  
DEFERRED PLAY  
F FWD  
REWIND  
06: RECORD STROBE  
07: RECORD EXIT  
09: PAUSE  
REC  
PUNCH OUT  
STOP  
40: WRITE  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
LOCATE to Setting Data  
CUE/REVIEW (+/- 1~60 times)  
CUE/REVIEW (+/- 1~60 times)  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
Refer to MMC Response/Information Field List  
41: MASKED WRITE  
42: READ  
44: LOCATE  
46: SEARCH  
47: SHUTTLE  
4C: MOVE  
4D: ADD  
4E: SUBTRACT  
MMC Response/Information Field List  
01: SELECTED TIME CODE  
03: REQUESTED OFFSET  
04: ACTUAL OFFSET  
08: GP 0  
Command  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE  
READ  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ/WRITE/MOVE/ADD/SUBTRACT  
READ  
09: GP 1  
0A: GP 2  
0B: GP 3  
0C: GP 4  
0D: GP 5  
0E: GP 6  
0F: GP 7  
48: MOTION CONTROL TALLY  
4C: RECORD MODE  
4E: TRACK RECORD STATUS  
4F: TRACK RECORD READY  
51: RECORD MONITOR  
READ/WRITE  
READ  
READ/WRITE/MASKED WRITE  
READ/WRITE  
Inquiry Message List  
IDENTITY REQUEST: F0, 7E, <channel>, 06, 01, F7  
IDENTITY REPLY: F0, 7E, <channel>, 06, 02, 51, 01, 00, 13, 03, **, **, **, **, F7  
51  
:Fostex ID  
01, 00  
13, 03  
**, **, **, **  
:Device family code  
:Device family number VF80  
:Software version  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
Maintenance  
Cleaning the exterior  
* For normal cleaning, use a soft dry cloth.  
For stubborn dirt, moisten a cloth in diluted detergent, wring it out firmly, and wipe the dirt off.  
Then polish with a dry cloth. Never use solvents such as alcohol, thinner or benzene, since these will  
damage the printing and finish of the exterior.  
Specifications  
Recording/Reproducing  
Recording Medium  
Recording Format  
Save/Load Format  
Sampling Frequency  
Quantization  
A/D Converter  
D/A Converter  
No. of Recording Track  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
3.5 inch, hard disk (E-IDE type)  
FDMS-3 (*)  
FDIO-1 (**)  
44.1kHz  
16-bit linear (Non expanded)  
20-bit 64 times, over sampling, Delta-Sigma  
24-bit 128 times, over sampling, Delta-Sigma  
8 real tracks + 16 additional tracks  
*2 tracks for simultaneous recording (Maximum)  
+/- 6%  
Vari Pitch Control  
Crossfade  
Recording/Reproducing Frequency  
:
:
:
10msec.  
20Hz ~ 20kHz  
Input/Output  
Input A, B  
Connector  
:
:
:
:
:
:
ø6mm Phone jack (Unbalanced)  
XLR-3-31 type connector (Balanced)  
50kor more (Unbalanced)  
1kor more (Balanced)  
Input Impedance  
Standard Input Level  
Phantom Power (XLR only)  
-50 ~ +4dBu  
+48VDC (Setting of ON/OFF with PHANTOM switch)  
HEADPHONE  
Connector  
Load Impedance  
Output Level  
:
:
:
ø6mm TRS Phone jack  
10~ 50Ω  
20mW or more (at 32)  
STEREO OUT L, R  
Connector  
Load Impedance  
Output Level  
:
:
:
ø6mm Phone jack  
10kor more  
-10dBV  
S/P DIF DIGITAL IN  
Connector  
Format  
:
:
COAXIAL  
IEC 60958 (S/P DIF)  
DIGITAL OUT  
Connector  
Format  
:
:
COAXIAL  
IEC 60958 (S/P DIF)  
MIDI IN/OUT  
Connector  
PUNCH IN/OUT  
Connector  
:
:
DIN 5 PIN  
ø6mm Phone jack (An optional FOOT SW Model 8051  
can be connected.)  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
General  
Dimensions  
Weight  
Power Supply  
Power Consumption  
:
:
:
:
307 (W) x 108 (H) x 217 (D) mm  
Approx. 3.2kg  
120VAC 60Hz, 230V~ 50/60Hz (AC inlet type)  
20W  
Accessories  
:
:
Owner’s manual  
Power Cable  
* Fostex Disk Management System-3  
** Fostex Data In Out-1  
Specifications and appearance are subject to change without notice for product improvement.  
Block Diagram  
L
R
EFF  
TRK 1  
PAN  
2BAND EQ  
GAIN  
MUTE  
EFFECT  
PAN  
PRE/POST  
ASP  
EFFECT  
PHANTOM (+48V)  
EFFECT  
SEND LEVEL  
MUTE  
EFFECT  
RTN LEVEL  
TRK 2  
2BAND EQ  
GAIN  
MUTE  
EFFECT  
PAN  
PRE/POST  
TRK 3  
PEAK  
ON  
to METER  
INPUT A  
2BAND EQ  
GAIN  
MUTE  
AD/C  
REC  
REC  
1
2
REP  
1
EFFECT  
PAN  
PRE/POST  
OFF  
REP  
REP  
2
3
TRK 4  
TRIM  
PHANTOM (+48V)  
REC  
REC  
REC  
REC  
REC  
3
4
5
6
7
2BAND EQ  
GAIN  
MUTE  
to METER  
REP  
REP  
REP  
REP  
REP  
4
5
6
7
8
EFFECT  
PAN  
PRE/POST  
HDR  
L
TRK 5  
DA/C  
MUTE  
GAIN  
2BAND EQ  
GAIN  
R
MUTE  
BOUNCE  
ST OUT  
EFFECT  
PAN  
PRE/POST  
MASTERING  
INPUT B  
ON  
REC  
8
TRK 6  
AD/C  
OFF  
2BAND EQ  
GAIN  
PEAK  
PHONES  
MUTE  
TRIM  
BOUNCE  
EFFECT  
PRE/POST  
TRK 7/8  
DATA OUT  
ENCODE  
BALANCE  
S/P DIF  
DATA IN  
MUTE  
DECODE  
GAIN  
S/P DIF  
2 TRK  
MASTERING  
EFFECT  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
Block Diagram (when using the insert effect)  
L
R
ON/OFF  
INSERT  
EFFECT  
OUT Level  
PHANTOM (+48V)  
TRK 1  
MUTE  
2BAND EQ  
PAN  
PAN  
PAN  
GAIN  
GAIN  
GAIN  
PEAK  
TRK 2  
MUTE  
2BAND EQ  
2BAND EQ  
2BAND EQ  
2BAND EQ  
2BAND EQ  
REC EFF  
to METER  
TRK 3  
MUTE  
INPUT A  
CH ON/OFF  
REC 1  
REP 1  
AD/C  
REC 2  
REC 3  
REC 4  
REC 5  
REC 6  
REP 2  
TRK 4  
MUTE  
PAN  
PAN  
TRIM  
PHANTOM (+48V)  
REP 3  
REP 4  
REP 5  
REP 6  
REP 7  
GAIN  
GAIN  
GAIN  
to METER  
TRK 5  
MUTE  
L
DA/C  
MUTE  
TRK 6  
MUTE  
GAIN  
PAN  
R
ST OUT  
REC 7  
REC 8  
Effect Track  
PHONES LEVEL  
TRK 7/8  
MUTE  
INPUT B  
REP 8  
AD/C  
GAIN  
BALANCE  
CH ON/OFF  
PHONES  
PEAK  
TRIM  
DATA OUT  
ENCODE  
S/P DIF  
DATA IN  
DECODE  
S/P DIF  
Normal  
Dimensions  
I N P U T  
O U T P U T  
I N P U T  
T A  
O U T P U T O F F O N  
M I D I  
A
S / P D I F  
/
D O M  
P H A N T  
W E  
P O  
R
307  
INPUT  
BAL  
A
ST OUT  
FOOT SW  
INPUT  
BAL  
B
PHONES  
L
R
MIX PARAMETER  
SCENE SCENE SEQ.  
TRACK  
EDIT  
GUITAR  
GUITAR  
DIGITAL MULTITRACKER  
PGM  
PAN  
FADER  
EQ  
MAP  
EFFECT  
LINE  
MIC  
LINE  
MIC  
MIN  
MAX  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
UNBAL  
TRIM  
ON/OFF  
ACCESS  
2TRK MODE  
BOUNCE  
MASTERING  
TRAINING  
CH ON/OFF  
CH ON/OFF  
PEAK  
PEAK  
PHANTOM  
F1  
F2  
F3  
REC EFF  
OFF  
RED  
REC  
GREEN  
MUTE  
PLAY  
TRACK STATUS  
STATUS  
/SEL  
TRACK STATUS / TRACK SEL  
JOG SHUTTLE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7/8 2TRK  
CURSOR  
MASTER  
EXIT  
/NO  
EJECT  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
+6  
0
ENTER  
/YES  
0
TIMEBASE  
UNDO  
/REDO  
SETUP  
F1  
SEL  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
F2  
F3  
SHIFT  
-10  
-20  
-10  
-20  
LOCATE  
WAVE FORM  
SCRUB  
AUTO  
PUNCH  
VARI  
LOOP  
EDIT  
PITCH  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
-30  
-40  
EDIT  
EDIT  
MARK  
DELETE  
RECORD  
STOP  
PLAY  
REWIND  
F
FWD  
-  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
-∞  
LOCATE ABS  
0
LOCATE REC END  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Declaration of EC Directive  
This equipment is compatible with the EMC Directive (89/336/EEC) - Directive on approximation of member  
nation's ordinance concerning the electromagnetic compatibility and with the Low Voltage Directive (73/23/EEC)  
- Directive on approximation of member nation's ordinance concerning electric equipment designed to be used  
within the specified voltage range.  
The Affect of Immunity on This Equipment  
The affect of the European Specification EN50082-1 (coexistence of electromagnetic waves - common  
immunity specification) on this equipment are as shown below.  
* In the electrical fast transient/burst requirements, surge, conducted disturbances by radio-frequency fields,  
power frequency magnetic field, radiate electromagnetic field requirements and static electricity discharging  
environment, this could be affected by generation of noise in some cases.  
FOSTEX DISTRIBUTORS LIST IN EUROPE  
* Including non-EU countries (as of January, 2002).  
<AUSTRIA>  
<ITALY>  
NAME: ATEC Audio-u. Videogeraete VertriebsgesmbH.  
ADD: Im Winkel 5, A-2325 Velm, Austria  
TEL: (+43) 2234-74004, FAX: (+43) 2234-74074  
NAME: Proel S.p.A.  
ADD: Zona Artigianale 64047-Sant’ Omero (Teramo), Italy  
TEL: (+39) 0861-81241, FAX: (+39) 0861-887862  
<THE NETHERLANDS>  
<BELGIUM>  
NAME: IEMKE ROOS AUDIO B. V.  
ADD: Kuiperbergweg 20, 1101 AG Amsterdam, The  
Netherlands  
NAME: EML Sound Industries NV  
ADD: Bijvennestraat 1A, B3500 Hasselt, Belgium  
TEL: (+32) 11-232355, FAX: (+32) 11-232172  
TEL: (+31) 20-697-2121, FAX: (+31) 20-697-4201  
<DENMARK>  
NAME: SC Sound ApS  
<NORWAY>  
NAME: Siv. Ing. Benum A/S  
ADD: P. O. Box 145 Vinderen, 0319 Oslo 3, Norway  
TEL: (+47) 22-139900, FAX: (+47) 22-148259  
ADD: Malervej 2, DK-2630 Taastrup, Denmark  
TEL: (+45) 4399-8877, FAX: (+45) 4399-8077  
<FINLAND>  
NAME: Noretron Oy Audio  
<PORTUGAL>  
NAME: Caius - Tecnologias Audio e Musica, Lda.  
ADD: Rua de Santa Catarina, 131 4000 Porto, Portugal  
TEL: (+351) 2-2086009/2001394  
ADD: P. O. Box 22, FIN-02631 Espoo, Finland  
TEL: (+358) 9-5259330, FAX: (+358) 9-52593352  
FAX: (+351) 2-2054760/2087488  
<FRANCE>  
NAME: Guillard Musiques  
ADD: ZAC de Folliouses, B. P. 609, Les Echets, 01706 Miribel,  
France  
<SPAIN>  
NAME: Multitracker, S. A.  
ADD: C/Garcilaso No.9, Madrid 28010, Spain  
TEL: (+34) 91-4470700, 91-4470898, FAX: (+34) 91-5930716  
TEL: (+33) 472 26 27 00, FAX: (+33) 472 26 27 01  
<GERMANY>  
NAME: Studiosound & Music GmbH  
<SWEDEN>  
NAME: TTS Scandinavia AB  
ADD: Kavallerivagen 24, 172 48 Sundbyberg, Sweden  
TEL: (+46) 8-59798000, FAX: (+46) 8-59798001  
ADD: Industriestrasse 20, D-35041 Marburg, F. R. Germany  
TEL: (+49) 6421-92510, FAX: (+49) 6421-925119  
<GREECE>  
NAME: Bon Studio S. A.  
<SWITZERLAND>  
NAME: Audio Bauer Pro AG  
ADD: Bernerstrasse-Nord 182, CH-8064 Zurich, Switzerland  
TEL: (+41) 1-4323230, FAX: (+41) 1-4326558  
ADD: 6 Zaimi Street, Exarchia, 106.83 Athens, Greece  
TEL: (+30) 1-3809605-8, 3302059, FAX: (+30) 1-3845755  
<ICELAND>  
<UK>  
NAME: SCV London  
ADD: 40 Chigwell Lane, Oakwood Hill Industrial Estate,  
Loughton, Essex IG10 3NY U.K.  
TEL: (+44) 020-8418-0778, FAX: (+44) 020-8418-0624  
NAME: I. D. elrf. electronic Ltd.  
ADD: ARMULA 38 108 REYKJAVIK, ICELAND  
TEL: (+354) 588 5010, FAX: (+354) 588 5011  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FOSTEX CORPORATION  
3-2-35, Musashino, Akishima-shi, Tokyo, Japan 196-0021  
FOSTEX AMERICA  
15431, Blackburn Ave., Norwalk, CA 90650, U. S. A.  
© PRINTED IN JAPAN JAN. 2002 8588 011 000 FX  
356698  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Elation Professional Musical Instrument DMX 512 User Manual
Electro Voice Portable Speaker DMC 1152B User Manual
Flymo Lawn Mower Turbo 400 User Manual
Fujitsu Scanner S300M User Manual
GE Air Conditioner AZ28E12D User Manual
GE Ice Tea Maker 106824 User Manual
GE Monogram Oven 30 Wall Oven User Manual
GE Monogram Refrigerator ZIS420NR User Manual
Gianni Industries Door EM NH500 Series User Manual
Gianni Industries Door GL 850 User Manual